9 Algebra PDF
9 Algebra PDF
9 Algebra PDF
S Y S T E M
Class 9
ALGEBRA
www.zambak.com
DISTRIBUTION
Zambak Yaynclk ve
Eitim Gereleri A..
Mahmutbey Merkez Mah.
Souksu Cad. No. 31 Tek-er Merkezi
Baclar / STANBUL
_______________________
Tel.: +90-212 604 21 00
Fax: +90-212 604 21 12
http://book.zambak.com
To the Teacher,
Analytic Analysis of Lines and Circles is designed to provide students with the
analytic geometry background needed for further college-level geometry
courses. Analytic geometry can be defined as algebraic analysis applied to
geometrical concepts and figures, or the use of geometrical
concepts and figures to illustrate algebraic forms.
Analytic geometry has many applications in different
branches of science and makes it easier to solve a wide
variety of problems. The goal of this text is to help students
develop the skills necessary for solving analytic geometry
problems, and then help students apply these skills. By the
end of the book, students will have a good understanding
of the analytic approach to solving problems. In addition,
we have provided many systematic explanations throughout
the text that will help instructors to reach the goals that
they have set for their students. As always, we have taken
particular care to create a book that students can read,
understand, and enjoy, and that will help students gain
confidence in their ability to use analytic geometry.
To the Student,
This book consists of two chapters, which cover analytical analysis of lines and
circles respectively. Each chapter begins with basic definitions, theorems, and
explanations which are necessary for understanding the subsequent chapter
material. In addition, each chapter is divided into subsections so that students
can follow the material easily.
Every subsection includes self-test Check Yourself problem sections followed by basic
examples illustrating the relevant definition, theorem, rule, or property. Teachers
should encourage their students to solve Check Yourself problems themselves
because these problems are fundemental to understanding and learning the related
subjects or sections. The answers to most Check Yourself problems are given directly
after the problems, so that students have immediate feedback on their progress.
Answers to some Check Yourself problems are not included in the answer key, as they
are basic problems which are covered in detail in the preceding text or examples.
Giving answers to such problems would effectively make the problems redundant,
so we have chosen to omit them, and leave students to find the basic answers
themselves.
At the end of every section there are exercises categorized according to the
structure and subject matter of the
section. Exercises are graded in order,
from easy (at the beginning) to difficult (at the end).
Exercises which involve more ability and effort are
denoted by one or two stars. In addition, exercises which
deal with more than one subject are included in a
separate bank of mixed problems at the end of the
section. This organization allows the instructor to deal
with only part of a section if necessary and to easily determine which exercises
are appropriate to assign.
Every chapter ends with three important sections.
The Chapter Summary is a list of important concepts and
formulas covered in the chapter that students can use
easily to get direct information whenever needed.
A Concept Check section contains questions about the
main concepts of the subjects
covered, especially about the definitions, theorems or
derived
formulas.
Finally, a Chapter Review Test section consists of three tests, each with sixteen
carefully-selected problems. The first test covers
primitive and basic problems. The second and third tests
include more complex problems. These tests help
students assess their ability in understanding the
coverage of the chapter.
The answers to the exercises and the tests are given at the end of the book so
that students can compare their solution with the correct answer.
Each chapter also includes some subjects which are denoted as optional. These
subjects complement the topic and give some additional
information. However, completion of optional sections is
left to the discretion of the teacher, who can take into
account regional curriculum requirements.
CHAPTER 1
SECTION 1: ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS
A. ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS . . . . . . . . .10
1. Translating Phrases into Algebraic Expressions .10
SECTION 2: INEQUALITIES
A. SOLVING INEQUALITIES IN ONE
VARIABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
1. Inequalities in One Variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
2. Graphing Inequalities on a Number Line . . . . .35
3. Properties of Inequality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
CHAPTER 2
SECTION 1: FONDAMENTALS OF
TRINGONOMETRY
2. Degree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
3. Radian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
1. Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
B. CALCULATING TRIGONOMETRIC
VALUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
1. Trigonometric Values of Quadrantal Angles . .168
2. Using a Reference Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
3. Calculating Ratios from a Given Ratio . . . . . .174
4. Trigonometric Values of Other Angles . . . . . . .176
EXERCISES 2.3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
CHAPTER 3
SECTION 1: REAL NUMBERS SEQUENCES
A. SEQUENCES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
1. Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
2. Criteria for the Existence of a Sequence . . . . .210
CHAPTER 4
SECTION 1: CLOCK ARITHMETIC AND
MODULA
A. CLOCK ARITHMETIC
AND MODULA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
1. Clock Arithmetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
2. The Concept of Modulus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
3. Clock Addition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
B. OPERATIONS IN MODULAR
ARITHMETIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
1. Modular Addition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
2. Modular Multiplication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
3. Solving Modular Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
4. Other Operations in Modular Arithmetic . . . . .290
5. Applications of Modular Arithmetic . . . . . . . . .292
B. PROPERTIES OF BINARY
OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
EXERCISES 4.1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
CHAPTER 5
SECTION 1: BASIC CONCEPTS AND
DEFINITIONS
EXERCISES 5.1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
SECTION 2: STATISTICS
A. BASIC CONCEPTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
1. What is Statistics? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
2. Collecting Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
3. Summarizing Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326
4. Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
EXERCISES 5.2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
CHAPTER REVIEW TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Objectives
A. ALGEBRAIC EXPRESSIONS
1. Translating Phrases into Algebraic Expressions
Algebra is a useful tool for solving some practical everyday problems. In order to use algebra,
we need to know how to translate a problem into algebraic notation. Let us look at an example.
Suppose you are fifteen years old now.
In one years time you will be (15 + 1) years old.
In two years time you will be (15 + 2) years old.
In three years time you will be (15 + 3) years old.
We can see that there is a pattern. We can write a more general expression:
In x years time you will be (15 + x) years old.
Here, x represents one or more numbers. x is called a variable.
Definition
variable
A variable is a letter that is used to represent a numerical quantity. We often use a lower-case
letter such as a, b, c, etc. for a variable.
In the example above, x represents a number of years. x is a variable, and 15 + x is called an
algebraic expression.
Definition
algebraic expression
An algebraic expression is a combination of numbers, variables, operations and grouping
signs.
10
Algebra 9
AL-K
KHWARIZMI
3y
(780-850)
One of the first books
about algebra was written in Arabic by a nineteenth-century scientist
called Muhammed bn
Musa Al-Khwarizmi. The
title of the book was
shortened to al-jabr, now
spelled algebra. The full
title meant that equals
can be added to both
sides of an equation.
Al-Khwarizmi used his
al-jabr to help him in his
scientific work in geography
and astronomy.
2x + 5y
3t2
5(n 2)
3ab(n m).
We can use the table on the next page to help translate verbal phrases into algebraic
expressions. We use these key words and phrases to represent the operations of addition,
subtraction, multiplication, and division.
Note
Be careful when translating phrases with the word less.
5 less than x means x 5, not 5 x.
Operation
Algebraic expressions
can contain more than
one variable.
3 y, 3 y and 3y all
represent the same
quantity. In this book, we
use the third notation:
3y, 4x, 5ab, etc.
Verbal phrase
Algebraic translation
a number plus 4
the sum of y and 7
a number added to 6
3 more than a number
a number 5 greater than n
k increased by 12
x+4
y+7
z+6
t+3
n+5
k + 12
9 minus a number
the difference of x and y
5 less than a number
4 subtracted from t
a number decreased by 8
9a
xy
b5
t4
c8
6 times a number
6a
mn
11x
2k
l
2
10
x
a
b
s
t
11
EXAMPLE
Solution
a. 13 + x
b. 3y 5
c. z2 7
Remember that we can use any letter as a variable, so we could also write 13 + a, 13 + b,
13 + c etc. or 3p 5, 3t 5, 3m 5 as answers in this example.
EXAMPLE
Solution
a. x2 + 6
b.
a2
8
c. 4y2
EXAMPLE
Solution
TOTAL
COST
C
price per
lahmacun
number of
lahmacun
number of
glasses of ayran
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
b.
c.
d.
e.
x
x+
x+1
x+1
x-1
x+
x+
x+
Solution
x+
x+
EXAMPLE
b.
c.
n
x
m
Solution
a. area = a a = a2
b. area = x y
c. area =
mn
2
13
Check Yourself 3
1. Translate each phrase into an algebraic expression.
a. 13 less than a number
b. the product of 3 and a number
c. 15 divided by a number
d. a number multiplied by 6
e. the quotient of the square of a number and another number
f. 5 more than a number, multiplied by 3
g. 7 times a number, less than 15
2. Match the phrases and the expressions.
1. 5 ( x + 4)
2. 2 ( x 3)
x2
5+ y
5
4. a +
b
5. ( x 3) 12
6.
3.
m
9n
b.
a
c.
z
a
x
a
d.
b
b
y
m+3
m+1
m
m+2
14
15
x2
d. 6x e.
x
y
f. (x + 5) 3 g. 15 7x 2. a. 3 b. 5 c. 1 d. 6
3. a. 3a b. x + y + z c. 5b d. 4m + 6
4. a. x 5 b. x + 3 c. x 4
Algebra 9
statement
An expression is called a statement (or proposition) if it contains an assertion which can be
assigned as true or false meaningfully.
For example, the following expressions are statements:
3 + 5 = 8 (a true statement)
A week contains 8 days. (a false statement)
7 > 9 (false).
The following expressions are not statements:
Is this a pen? (there is no assertion, so this is not a statement)
The volume of a cube is negative. (not meaningful, so not a statement).
Definition
equation
An equation is a statement which contains an equality (=) symbol between two expressions.
For example, 2x + 7 = 11 is an equation. The expression 2x + 7 is on th left-hand side of
the equation and 11 is on the right-hand side of the equation. The letter x is the variable (or
unknown).
variable (or unknown)
coefficient
2 x + 7 = 11
open sentence
An equation containing one or more variables is called an open sentence.
For example, the equation 5x 4 = 11 is an open sentence. It might be true or false, depending
on the value of x.
If x = 3, the equation is true, because when we substitute 3 for x, we get 11:
5 (3) 4 = 15 4 = 11. But the equation is false for any other value of x.
15
Definition
solution of an equation
A number is called a solution of an equation if it makes the statement true.
For example, is 3 a solution of 3x 12 = 3? Let us substitute 3 for x:
?
3 (3) 12 = 3
?
9 12 = 3
?
EXAMPLE
Solution
Is 2 a solution of 2x + 7 = 12?
We substitute 2 for x:
2x + 7 = 12
?
2 (2) + 7 = 12
?
4 + 7 = 12.
Since 4 + 7 = 12 is false, 2 is not a solution.
In our examples, we have found only one solution for each equation. Sometimes an equation
can have more than one solution. Sometimes we also need to specify the set of numbers that
we can substitute for a variable.
For example, imagine a bus has fifty seats and x passengers. The equation y = 50 x tells us
the number of empty seats (y) on the bus. Can x be 40?
1
Can x be 20 ? Can x be ? Can x be 100? Clearly only some of these numbers are possible
2
for x: we cannot have half a passenger, or passengers.
Definition
replacement set
The set of numbers that may be substituted for the variable in an equation is called the
replacement set of the equation.
For example, the replacement set for the bus passenger equation above is {x | x W, 0 x 50}.
The set of all numbers from the replacement set which make an equation true is called the
solution set of the equation.
16
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
Solution
If a = 2 then
If a = 3 then
3 + 2a = 7
3 + 2a = 7
3 + 2a = 7
3 + 2 (1) = 7
3 + 2 (2) = 7
3 + 2 (3) = 7
3+2=7
3+4=7
3+6=7
7 = 7 TRUE.
5 = 7 FALSE.
9 = 7 FALSE.
If two equations have the same solution set S over the same replacement set then they are
called equivalent equations.
For example,
2x + 7 = 11 (S = {2}) and
x 2 = 0 (S = {2})
are equivalent equations.
EXAMPLE
Solution
If x = 2 then
If x = 3 then
3 (1) + 8 = 12
3 (2) + 8 = 12
3 (3) + 8 = 12
3 + 8 = 12
6 + 8 = 12
9 + 8 = 12
5 = 12 FALSE.
14 = 12 FALSE.
17 = 12 FALSE.
In this example, the given replacement set does not contain a solution of this equation. So the
solution set is S = , the empty set.
Definition
empty set
The solution set of an equation is called the empty set when none of the numbers from the
replacement set satisfy the equation. We write { } or to mean the empty set.
17
Check Yourself 3
1. Which of the following expressions are statements? If the expression is a statement, determine whether it is true or false.
a. 4 is an even number.
b. -In any right triangle, the sum of the squares of legs is equal to the square of the
hypotenuse.
c. 32 22 = 5
d. 3 + 5 = 9
e. 5x 7
f. x > 5
g. 11 < 10
2. Determine whether each statement is an equation or not.
a. 5x = 15
b. 3x 7
d. 3x 5y = 4
e. 3a + 1 = 3a + 1
c. 4x + y = 9x + 2
b. x 3 = 7 (4)
c. x + 7 = 7 (0)
d. y 5 = 0 (5)
e. 3z (1 z) = 11 (3)
f. 3x + 1 = 8 (3)
g. 3 (3 2x) + 7 = 16 (2)
h. 5 (1 2x) + 5x + 1 = 1 (1)
Answers
1. a. a true statement b. A true statement c. a true statement d. a false statement e. not
a statement f. not a statement g. a false statement
2. a. an equation b. not an equation c. an equation d. an equation e. an equation
3. a. 3x + 5 b. 5x 2 c. 7x 1 d. 3x 5
4. a. yes b. no c. yes d. no e. yes f. yes g. no h. no
18
Algebra 9
Note
In the rest of this book, if there is no replacement set specified for a problem, the replacement
set is R.
Definition
linear equation
A linear equation (or first degree equation) in one unknown is an equation that can be written
in the form ax + b = 0 where a and b are real numbers, a 0 and x is a variable.
19
More generally, adding the same quantity to both sides of an equation does not change the
equality. We can write this property algebraically as the addition property of equality.
Property
If a = b then a + c = b + c.
EXAMPLE
Solution
Solve x 4 = 9 over Z.
x4=9
x 4 + 4 = 9 + 4 (add 4 to both sides)
x = 13
Let us check the solution:
x4=9
(13) 4 = 9 (substitute 13 for x)
9 = 9.
Since 9 = 9, 13 is the solution of the equation.
EXAMPLE
10
Solution
There are a + 5 grams on the left side and 8 grams on the right side of a balanced set of
scales. Find a.
Let us remove five grams from both sides:
a+5=8
a+55=85
a = 3.
More generally, subtracting the same quantity from both sides
of an equation does not change the equality. This gives us a
second property of equality:
Property
20
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
11
Solution
Solve x + 7 = 11 over Z.
x + 7 = 11
x + 7 7 = 11 7 (subtract 7 from both sides)
x=4
Check:
x + 7 = 11 (original equation)
(4) + 7 = 11 (substitute 4 for x)
11 = 11. This is true, so 4 is the solution.
Now consider the scales on the right. The scales are balanced.
Dividing the quantities into two equal parts and removing one half
from both sides will give us
2x = 8
2x = 2 4 (factorize 8 as 2 4)
2x
24
=
(divide both sides by 2)
2
2
1x = 14 (
x = 4.
2
=1)
2
More generally, dividing both sides of an equation by the same non-zero number does not
change the equality.
division property of equality
Property
If a = b then
EXAMPLE
12
a b
, where c 0.
c c
Solve 4x = 10 over Z.
4x = 20
Solution
4x
45
=
(divide both sides by 4)
4
4
4
1 x = 1 5 ( =1 )
4
x=5
21
Check:
4x = 20 (original equation)
4 (5) = 20 (substitute 5 for x)
20 = 20. This is true, so 5 is the solution.
Finally, consider the scales on the right. They are balanced.
Since the weights on both sides are equal, we can double the
weight on both sides:
x
= 3 (original equation)
2
2
x
= 3 2 (multiply both sides by 2)
2
x 6 (simplify both sides,
2
=1).
2
More generally, multiplying both sides of an equation by the same number does not change
the equality.
Property
If a = b then a c = b c.
EXAMPLE
13
Solution
Solve
x
= 4 over Z.
6
x
4
6
x
6 4 6 (multiply both sides by 6)
6
6
1)
x 24 (simplify both sides,
6
Check:
x
= 4 (original expression)
6
(24)
= 4 (replace 24 for x)
6
4 = 4. This is true, so x = 24 is the solution.
22
Algebra 9
a
a
x
EXAMPLE
10
Solution
b
.
a
(simplify)
Solve 2x 5 = 0.
There is no replacement set specified, so we
will solve over R.
We need to isolate the variable x on one side
of the equation.
2x 5 = 0
(original equation)
Check:
2x 5 = 0 (original equation)
5
2 ( )5 = 0
2
55=0 (
5
for x)
2
2
= 1)
2
0=0
(substitute
So x =
5
is the solution.
2
(simplify)
23
EXAMPLE
15
Solution
Solve 2x + 3 = 7 over Z.
2x + 3 3 = 7 3 (subtract 3 from both sides)
Check:
2x = 4
2x
4
=
2
2
x=2
2x + 3 = 7
2(2) + 3 = 7
4+3=7
7=7
(simplify)
So x = 2 is the solution.
EXAMPLE
16
Solution
3
Solve x 5 2 over Z.
4
3
x 5 5 2 5 (subtract 5 from both sides)
4
3
x 3
4
3
4 ( x) 3 4 (multiply both sides by 4)
4
3x 12
3 x 12
3
3
Check:
3
x5 2
4
3
4 5 2
4
3 5 2
22
So x = 4 is the solution.
x4
EXAMPLE
17
Solution
Solve
3x 4
4 over Z.
5
3x 4
4
5
3x 4
45
5
5
3x 4 20
(simplify)
3 x 24
3
3
x8
24
Check:
3x 4
4
5
(original equation)
3 (8) 4
4
5
24 4
4
5
44
So x 8 is the solution.
(simplify)
Algebra 9
like terms
Terms of an expression which have the same variables and the same exponents are called like
terms.
For example, 5x and 3x are like terms. 6a2 and 2a2 are also like terms.
3x and 7y are not like terms.
To combine like terms, we add or subtract their numerical coefficients and keep the same
variables with the same exponents.
For example, let us solve the equation 3x + 4x + 7x = 42 by combining the like terms:
(3 + 4 + 7)x = 42, 14x = 42,
EXAMPLE
18
14 x 42
3. So x 3 is the solution.
14
14
Solve 4x + 12 + x = 27.
Solution
Check:
4x + 12 + x = 27
4x + x + 12 = 27
(4 + 1) x + 12 = 27
5x + 12 = 27
5x + 12 12 = 27 12
5x = 15
5 x 15
=
5
5
x=3
Property
4x + 12 + x = 27
(combine like terms)
(simplify)
(subtract 12 from both sides)
4 (3) + 12 + (3) = 27
12 + 12 + 3 = 27
27 = 27
(simplify)
(divide both sides by 5)
(simplify)
25
For example,
x+2
Area = 3(x + 2)
Area = 3x
Area=32
EXAMPLE
19
Solution
Solve 2x + 3 (2x 4) = 8.
Check:
(2 5) + 3 ((2 5) 4) = 10 + 3 (10 4)
= 10 + (3 6)
= 10 + 18 = 8
26
Algebra 9
20
Solution
Solve 5x 13 = x + 5.
The left-hand side has the largest coefficient of x (5x), so we collect the variables on this side
of the equation:
5x + x 13 = x + x + 5 (to eliminate the x from the right side, we can add
+x to both sides)
6x 13 = 5
6x 13 + 13 = 5 + 13
6x = 18
6 x 18
=
6
6
x = 3.
Check:
5x 13 = x + 5
5 3 13 = 3 + 5
15 13 = 3 + 5
2 = 2. So x = 3 is the solution.
A quicker way to add or subtract a quantity in an equation involves moving the quantity to
the other side of the equation. However, when we move a quantity to the opposite side, the
sign changes. For example:
x+b=c
x+b=c
x=cb
and
yd=e
yd=e
y = e + d.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
27
EXAMPLE
21
Solution
2x + 5 (6 3x) = 7 4x
2x + 5 6 5 3x = 7 4x
2x + 30 15x = 7 4x
30 13x = 7 4x
30 13x = 7 4x
30 7 = 13x 4x
23 = 9x
23
= x.
9
Check:
2 x 5 (6 3 x) 7 4 x
2
23
23
23
5 (6 3 ) 7 4
9
9
9
46 75
29
9
9
9
EXAMPLE
22
29
29
23
, so x
is the solution.
9
9
9
Solve 3x 5 = 13.
Solution
Check:
3x 5 =
36 5 =
18 5 =
13 =
28
13
13
13
13, so x = 6 is the solution.
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
23
Solution
10 5x = 7x 14
+5x
14 + 10 = 7x + 5x
24 = 12x
24
12 x
=
12
12
2=x
Check:
2 (5 4x) + 3x = 7x 14
2 (5 4 2) + 3 2 = 7 2 14
2 (3) + 6 = 14 14
6 + 6 = 0
0 = 0, so x = 2 is the solution.
Definition
identity
An equation which is true for all possible values of the variable(s) in the equation is called an
identity.
For example, consider the equation 2x + 6 = 2 (x + 3). We can rewrite it as
2x + 6 = 2 x + 2 3
2x + 6 = 2x + 6.
We can see that 2x + 6 = 2(x + 3) is true for any value of x, because the two sides are
identical. So the solution set is the set of all real numbers, and the equation is an identity.
EXAMPLE
24
Solution
Solve
5 3 (x 6) + 3 = 3 2 (x + 4) (x 30) + 1.
5 3 (x 6) + 3 = 3 2 (x + 4) (x 30) + 1
5 3x + 18 + 3 = 3 2x 8 x + 30 + 1
3x + 26 = 3x + 26
3x = 3x + 26 26
3x = 3x
x=x
So the solution set is the set of all real numbers.
29
Note
An impossible equation has no solution. The solution set is the empty set, .
Definition
impossible equation
An equation which is not true for any possible value of the variable(s) it contains is called a
contradiction (or impossible equation).
For example, consider the equation x + 1 = x + 5.
If we subtract x from both sides we get
xx+1=xx+5
1 = 5 which is false.
So this equation is an impossible equation and the solution set S is empty: S = .
EXAMPLE
25
Solve
5 (x 3) + 2 = 2 (x+4) + 3x.
Solution
5 (x 3) + 2 = 2 (x + 4) + 3x
5x 15 + 2 = 2x + 8 + 3x
5x 13 = 5x + 8
5x 5x 13 = 5x 5x + 8
13 = 8
This is a contradiction, so S = .
EXAMPLE
26
Solve
2x
4
3
.
x2
x2
2x
4
3
x2
x2
Solution
( x 2) (
( x 2)
2x
4
( x 2) (multiply both sides by x 2)
3)
x 2
x2
2x
3 ( x 2) 4
x 2
2x + 3x 6 = 4
5x 6 = 4
(distributive property)
(simplify)
+6
5x = 4 + 6
5x = 10
5 x 10
=
5
5
x=2
30
Algebra 9
Check:
2x
4
3
x2
x2
(original equation)
2.2
4
3
2 2
22
(substitute 2 for x)
4
4
3
0
0
This equation is meaningless, because any number divided by zero is undefined. So S = :
Check Yourself 4
1. Find x in each equation. Show your working and check your answer.
a. x + 5 = 0
e.
2
5
z
3
6
i. 2 x = 7
m.
b. x 4 = 0
3
2
m
5
5
f.
j.
3 x
1
3
2
c. x + 3 = 7
d. y 4 = 2
5 11
6 6
h. x 4 = 8
g. n
k.
x 7
3 12
l.
3x 9
2
2
x
7
2
3x 7
5
2
b. 5 4x = 13
e.
8 5x
7
3
c. 6 + 2x = 28
f.
13 6 x
2
4
g. 2 (3 + x) = 6
h. 3 (2 x) = 9
i. 6 (5x 3) = 15
j. 3x + 2 (1 + 3x) = 17
k. 7x 2 (5 3x) = 10
l. 8x (3x 5) = 15
m. 6 (2 + 4x) + 5 (4 3x) = 7x 19
n. 7 (2x + 1) + 12 = 5 (2x 2)
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
31
x 1 x 3
2
3
6
b.
3x 1
15 3x
3
c.
x2 x3 7
3
4
12
d.
1
x 2 2x 1
x
2
5
10
e.
5x 3 3x 5 2( x 1)
4
3
7
f.
4x 1 1 3 x 5 x 2
6
4
3
3x 2 4x 7 1 3x
1
g.
3
6
12
i.
1
x
3x 1
1
x 1
h.
1 2
1
x
1
Answers
1. a. 5 b. 4 c. 4 d. 2 e.
9
1
1
7
f.
g. 1 h. 4 i. 9 j.
k.
l. 3 m. 14
6
5
4
2
2. a. 3 b. 2 c. 11 d. 1 e.
3. a.
32
7
13
29
51
11
5
f.
g. 0 h. 5 i.
j.
k. 20 l. 2 m.
n.
5
4
2
10
3
2
11
6
7
7
23
227
b.
c.
d.
e.
f. 1 g.
h. 3 i. 1
9
7
23
3
3
3
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
1 .1
c.
5x 4
12
2
b. 3(4 2x) + 2 = 17
d.
7 13 x
5
3
b. a + 3 = 8 (4)
c. 4(x + 2) = 8 (0)
d. 3(2x 4) = 15 (4)
e. 5(3x 7) + 6 = 16 (3)
f. 6(4 2x) 7x + 5 = 5 (1)
x 2 x 1
3
4
2
c.
3x 1 x 4
2x 7
1
5
3
15
d.
5x 1 6 x
4 x
3x
9
3
9
b.
4x 3
4 x
2
6
3
4
3
x 2
e.
4
5
2
3x
2
4
5
3x 5
6
x3 x
x3
6
1
b. 4x + 2 = 6
c. 8(3 2x) + 12 7x = 15
d. 3(4x 1) + 16 = x 3
b. 5(x 3) 9 = 11
c. 2(4 + x) + 7 = 8 + x
d. 3x + 5 2(6 3x) = 19
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
12
4
b.
c. 6
3
4
4x 1 2
x 3
3
6
3
x 1
a.
7 2 x 4 x 16
1
x 2x 5
b.
1
4
2
x
x
33
Objectives
inequality
A statement which contains an inequality symbol between two algebraic expressions is called
an inequality.
There are five types of inequality. We use a different inequaltiy symbol for each type.
>
means
is greater than
means
<
means
is less than
means
means
is not equal to
For example,
5 > 3 means 5 is greater than 3
2 < 9 means 2 is less than 9
4 3 means 4 is greater than or equal to 3
3 1 means 3 is less than or equal to 1
5 5 means 5 is not equal to 5.
34
Algebra 9
27
Solution
Determine whether each number in the replacement set {1, 4, 5} is a solution of the inequality
2x 1 > 3 or not.
If x = 1 then
21 1 > 3
21>3
1 > 3.
If x = 4 then
FALSE
2 (4) 1 > 3
81>3
7 > 3.
If x = 5 then
TRUE
2 (5) 1 > 3
10 1 > 3
9 > 3. TRUE
Note
1. An open circle on a number line graph shows that the point is
not a solution:
x 3 (3 is not a solution)
-1
1 2
x 2 (2 is a solution)
x 5 (5 is a solution).
-1
35
However, the solution set of an inequality in one variable usually contains an infinite number
of values. To show this infinite number of solutions, we can use a number line graph. The
table below shows an example of each type of linear inequality on a real number line graph.
EXAMPLE
28
Solution
EXAMPLE
29
Solution
EXAMPLE
30
Solution
Inequality
Verbal phrase
Graph
x>3
-3 -2
x2
-2
x < 1
x5
x3
-1
-1
-1
-4
-3 -2
-3 -2
-1
-1
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
1
on a number line.
2
1
2
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1
Check Yourself 5
1. Graph each inequality on a number line.
a. x < 3
e. x 2
i. x 2
36
1
2
b. x > 1
c. x
1
2
d. x
f. x 5
g. x
3
2
h. x 3
j.
2
3
3
4
k. x 0.54
Algebra 9
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
b.
d.
-3
-2
-1
-4
-3
-2
-1
f.
Answers
1. a.
c.
e.
g.
i.
k.
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1 - 1 0
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2 - 3 -1
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1
0,54
b.
d.
f.
h.
j.
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1
-6
-5
-4
-3 -2
-1
-3
-2
-1
-3
-2
-1
3
4
2
3
2. a. x = 1 b. x > 1 c. x < 2 d. x 1 e. x 3 f. x 3
3. Properties of Inequality
The scales on the right show 7 > 3.
If we remove two grams from each side, we get
7>3
72>32
5 > 1.
More generally, subtracting the same real number from both sides of an inequality does not
change the inequality.
Property
37
Property
x
32
2
x 6.
More generally, if we multiply both sides of an inequality by a positive number then the
direction of the resulting inequality remains the same.
If we multiply both sides of an inequality by a negative number then the direction of the
resulting inequality must be reversed.
Property
38
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
31
Solution
Second way
Multiply both sides by 1:
4 x > 4
+x
(1) . (x) > 4 . (1)
x < 4.
4 > x or x < 4
2
2
x 4.
More generally, if we divide both sides of an inequality by a positive number then the direction
of the resulting inequality remains the same.
If we divide both sides of an inequality by a negative number then the direction of the resulting
inequality must be reversed.
Property
a b
.
c c
a b
.
c c
39
4
4
4 3.
4 4
6 5.
EXAMPLE
32
Solution
5
5
x 4
Property
Check Yourself 6
1. Solve the inequalities.
a. x + 3 < 5
b. 2 + x > 10
c. x 1 5
d. 3 + x < 15
e. 5 + x 8
f. x 6 7
g. 2x 8
h. 3x 6
i. 4x > 7
j. 7x < 21
k. 5x 20
l. 27 9x
m.
x
4
2
q.
40
x
3
5
4
n.
x
4
3
r.
x
0
3
o.
x 1
6 3
p.
x
2
4
Algebra 9
Answers
1. a. x < 2 b. x > 12 c. x 6 d. x < 18 e. x 13 f. x 1 g. x 4 h. x 2 i. x
j. x > 3 k. x 4 l. x 3 m. x 8 n. x < 12 o. x 2 p. x < 8 q. x
15
r. x 0
4
7
4
4. Solving Inequalities
To solve some inequalities we need to use more than one property of inequality.
We usually use the following strategies to solve an inequality:
1. Simplify both sides of the inequality by combining like terms and removing parentheses.
2. Add or subtract the same expression on both sides of the inequality.
3. Multiply or divide both sides of the inequality by the same positive expression
(or multiply or divide both sides of the inequality by the same negative expression and
reverse the inequality).
EXAMPLE
33
Solve 5x + 4 > 9.
Solution
5x + 4 > 9
5x + 4 4 > 9 4 (subtract 4 from both sides)
5x > 5
5x
5
>
5
5
x>1
Remember: if there is no
specified replacement
set for a problem, then
the replacement set is R.
(simplify)
(divide both sides by 5)
(simplify)
EXAMPLE
34
-1
Solve 13 3x 8.
13 3x 8
Solution
3
3
x7
(simplify)
(divide both sides by 3 and reverse the inequality)
10 11
.
41
EXAMPLE
35
Solution
Solve 6 + 5x 4 2x.
6 + 5x 4 2x
6 + 5x 6 4 2x 6
5x 2x 2
(simplify)
7 x 2
7
7
2
7
(simplify)
2
7
2
The solution set is {x| x
, x R } or
7
EXAMPLE
36
Solution
-1
.
0
7 2 (x 4) < 5 + 3x
7 + (2) x + (2) (4) < 5 + 3x
7 2x + 8 < 5 + 3x
15 2x < 5 + 3x
15 2x 5 < 5 + 3x 5
10 2x < 3x
10 < 5x
(simplify)
(combine like terms)
(subtract 5 from both sides)
(add 2x to both sides)
(simplify)
5x
10
<
5
5
2<x
x>2
(remove parentheses)
(simplify)
10 2x + 2x < 3x + 2x
42
-3 -2
-1
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
37
Solution
5 2 (2 3 x)
9.
3
Solve
3
5 2 (2 3 x)
> 9 3 (multiply both sides by 3)
3
5 + 2 (2 3x) > 27
(remove parentheses)
5 + 4 6x > 27
(simplify)
9 6x > 27
(simplify)
6 x 18
<
6
6
x < 3 (simplify)
The solution set is {x|x < 3, x R } or
EXAMPLE
38
Solution
-7
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
4 (3x 1)
x 2.
3
Solve
4 (3x 1)
> 3 (x 2)
3
4 (3x + 1) > 3 (x 2)
3x
12x + 4 > 3x 6
12x 3x > 6 4
9x > 10
9x
10
>
9
9
x>
10
9
10
, x R } or
9
10
9
-3
-2
-1
43
EXAMPLE
39
Solve
x 3 2x 1
x3
2
.
3
2
6
x 3 2x 1
x3
2
3
2
1
6
Solution
(2)
(3)
(6)
(1)
2 ( x 3) 3 (2 x 1) 12 ( x 3)
6
6
2( x 3) 3(2 x 1) 12 ( x 3)
(remove parentheses)
2 x 6 6 x 3 12 x 3
4 x 9 15 x
4 x x 15 9
(transpose x and 9)
3x 24
3x 24
3
3
x 8
(simplify)
EXAMPLE
40
Solution
Solve
-11 -10 -9
-8
-7
-6
-5
3x 4
5.
x2
( x 2)
3x 4
5 (x 2)
( x 2)
3x + 4 5 (x 2)
3x + 4 5x 10
4 + 10 5x 3x
14 2x
2x
14
2
2
x7
So the solution set is all real numbers less than or equal to 7, except 2:
S = {x|x 7, x R { 2}} or
44
10 11 12 13
Algebra 9
Check Yourself 7
1. Solve each inequality and graph its solution set on a number line.
a. x 3 > 6
b. 5 + x 2
c. 6 x < 4
d. 3x 7 > 2
e. 5x 7 8
f. 2x + 5 1
g. 9 4x < 3
h. 3x 1 3 + x
i. 2x 2 3+x
j. 2x 2 < 4x+2
k. 3 3 (2 x) 6
l. 6 4 (x + 2) 2
m. 12 (x 2) > 2x 4
n. 2 (3 + 5x) < 8x + 3
o.
x3
3
2
r.
x
x
2
2
3
w.
x 1
1
x 1
p.
5 4x
1
3
q.
x3
x 1
2
s.
3 (5x 1)
6
7
t.
3 (6 4 x)
2 x 5
2
3 x 2x 5 1
v.
4
3
6
x. x (4x 1) (2x + 1)2
u.
x 3 2x 1
x 1
1
5
3
15
Answers
1. a. x > 9 b. x 7 c. x > 2 d. x > 3 e. x 3 f. x 3 g. x > 3 h. x 2 i. x 5 j. x > 2
3
o. x < 9 p. x 1 q. x < 5 r. x 12 s. x < 3
2
5
2
1
13
5
1
t. x
u. x
v. x
w. x. x
11
4
5
2
k. x 1 l. x 0 m. x > 2 n. x
5. Written Problems
We can solve problems which contain phrases such as no more than, at most, no less than
and at least by using inequalities.
We translate the phrases as follows:
Phrase
Algebraic expression
xy
x is at most y
xy
xy
x is at least y
xy
45
EXAMPLE
41
Solution
Ali has four math exams. He needs an average of 85% to pass the year. His first three grades
are 78%, 80% and 85%. What grade does Ali need in the last exam to get an average of 85%?
The arithmetic mean (average) of Alis grades must be greater than or equal to 85.
Let x be the fourth exam grade, then we can write:
243 x
85 ; 243 + x 4 85;
4
243 + x 340;
78 80 85 x
85;
4
x 340 243;
x 97.
So Ali must get at least 97% in his fourth exam to pass the year.
EXAMPLE
42
Solution
Find the smallest four consecutive even integers whose sum is greater than 68.
Let x be the smallest even integer in the group. Then we can write:
x + (x + 2) + (x + 4) + (x + 6) > 68
4x + 12 > 68
4x > 68 12
4x > 56
x>
56
4
x > 14.
So the numbers are 16, 18, 20 and 22.
Check Yourself 8
1. When 3 is added to two times a number, the result is greater than or equal to 15. Find the
possible values of this number.
2. Three-fifths of a number is added to 2, giving a result of at least 5. What is the number?
3. Five times a number, minus 7, is not more than 8. Find the number.
4. Ahmet has a total of 155 points in his first three math exams. He needs an average of at
least 60 points to pass the year. How many points does Ahmet need to get in his fourth
and final math exam if he wants to pass the year?
Answers
1. x 6 2. x 5 3. x 3 4. x 85
46
Algebra 9
6. Compound Inequalities
Definition
compound inequality
A statement that contains two simple inequalities is called a compound inequality.
For example, 1 < x < 5 is a compound inequality. x > 7 is not a compound inequality (it is
a simple inequality).
There are many types of compound inequality. Let us look at some examples.
EXAMPLE
43
Solution
-3 -2
-1
-1
x > 1
x3
1 < x 3
EXAMPLE
44
Solve 9 2x + 3 < 11 over each set and show the solution on a number line.
a. Z
Solution
b. N
c. R
2
2
2
6 x < 4.
So the solution set is all the integers between 6 and 4:
{6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0 , 1, 2, 3}.
-7 -6
-5 -4
-3
-2
-1
47
b. The solution set is all the natural numbers between 6 and 4: {1, 2, 3}.
-6
-5 -4
-3
-2
-1
c. The solution set is all the real numbers between 6 and 4, including 6:
-7 -6
EXAMPLE
45
Solution
-5 -4
-3
-2
-1
-4
-3
-2
-1
-4
-3
-2
-1
-4
-3
-2
-1
x 2
x>2
x 2 or x > 2
46
Solution
Solve 4 3x + 2 < 5 over R and graph the solution set on a number line.
The compound inequality 4 3x+2 < 5 is equivalent to the two simple inequalities
4 3x+2 and 3x + 2 < 5.
Let us solve each of these simple inequalities separately:
4 3x + 2
4 2 3x + 2 2
3x + 2 < 5
3x + 2 2 < 5 2
6 3x
(simplify)
3x < 3
6
3x
2
3
3x
3
<
3
3
2 x
(simplify)
x < 1.
So the solution set is all x for which 2 x and x < 1, or {x|2 x < 1, x R}.
-3
EXAMPLE
48
47
-2
-1
Solution
(simplify)
2
2x 8
<
2
2
2
1 < x < 4.
(simplify)
EXAMPLE
48
Solution
Solve 2
2
-2
-1
2 4x
6 over R.
3
2 4x
6
3
2 3 3 (
2 4x
) 6 3 (multiply each side by 3 to remove the denominator)
3
6 2 4 x 18
(simplify)
(simplify)
8 4 x 16
4
4
4
2 x 4
4 x 2
(simplify)
(reverse the order)
-3
-2
-1
Check Yourself 9
1. Graph the solution set of each compound inequality over R on a number line.
a. 2 < x + 1 < 3
b. 7 3x + 2 < 8
d. 5 4 3x < 2
e. 2 1
g. 4x + 3 < 5x + 7 < x + 8
h.
x
3
3
c. 6 < 2x 3 5
f.
3x 2 1
3
3
1 x 1 3x
2
3
4
49
EXERCISES
1 .2
4. Solve each inequality.
a. 5 x < 7
b. 2x + 1 < 5
c. 3x 1 8
d. 2x 3 5
e. 3x 7 < 1
f. 4x + 1 9
b. x > 2
5
3
e. x 3
3
5
h. x 0.25
j. x 3
c. x
1
2
b. 2x + 3 5 + 3x
c. 9 2x > 13 6x
d. 12 13x 15x 15
e. 2(x + 1) < 4 x
f. 4 3 (x 1) < 5
3x 2
2x 2
2
b.
2 ( x 3)
3x 6
5
c. 3 2 x
d.
1 5x 2 2 x 1
2
5
10
e.
x 1 x 1 4x 3
8
3
12
f. x 4
i. 4 x
3x 1
1 x
3
2
2
k. x 1
a number line.
b. x + 3 6
c. x+5 1
d. x 2 3
e. 5 + x < 3
f. x 1 < 6
g. 2x 4
h. 3x < 6
i. 4x 8
j.
50
x
1
3
k.
x
0
2
l.
x 1
3 2
a. 3 < x 5
b. 2 < x 5 < 3
c. 5 < x + 2 < 7
d. 4 < 2 x < 6
e. 3 < 2x + 1 < 5
f. 5 3x 2 < 7
g. 3 1
x
4
3
h. 3 2x < x + 1 < 2x + 5
i. 2 x < 6 < 4 x j.
2 x 1 2x 1
3
4
6
Objectives
negative direction
-8
-7
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
negative integers
origin positive integers
(reference point)
For example, let us graph the points A, B, C, D and E which are represented by the numbers
3, 1, 4, 0 and 5 respectively on a number line:
C(-4) A(-3)
-5 -4
-3
-2
D(0) B(1)
-1
E(5)
2
A number which represents a point on a graph is called the coordinate of the point.
For example, the coordinate of A on the number line above is 3 and written as A(3).
The coordinates of the other points are B(1), C(4), D(0) and E(5).
Now let us consider the position of a point in a plane.
51
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Quadrant
II
y-axis
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
x-axis
origin
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
Quadrant
-5
IV
-6
-7
-8
Quadrant
III
x<0
y>0
Quadrant
I
y
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
-7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
x<0
-6
y<0
-7
x>0
y>0
P(4, 3)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 x
x>0
y<0
P(4, 3)
x-coordinate (abscissa)
y-coordinate (ordinate)
To graph the coordinates (4, 3), we start from the origin and move four units to the right and
three units up. The finishing point is the graph of (4, 3).
52
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
49
Solution
A(4, 3)
move four units
to the right
y
B(-3, 4)
move three
units down
B(3, 4)
move three
units to the left
-6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
move four
units up
EXAMPLE
50
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 x
-1
-2
-3
A(4, -3)
-4
-5
-6
b. B(2, 4)
c. C(5, 3)
d. D(4, 1)
e. E(0, 0)
f. F(0, 6)
g. G(5, 0)
3
h. H(1, )
2
Solution
y
B(-2, 4)
-6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
H(-1, - 3 )
2
C(-5, -3)
6 F(0, 6)
5
4
A(3, 3)
3
2
1
G(5, 0)
E(0, 0)
1 2 3 4 5 6 x
-1
D(4, -1)
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
From the previous example we can see that the coordinates of the origin are (0, 0). All the
points with an x-coordinate of zero lie on the y-axis, and all the points with a y-coordinate of
zero lie on the x-axis.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
53
EXAMPLE
51
Solution A(7, 3)
G(3, 0)
B(3, 6)
H(0, 0)
C(2, 2)
I(6, 1)
D(2, 5)
J(4, 4)
E(5, 3)
K(3, 4)
F(0, 5)
L(4, 0)
y
8
7
B
6
D
F 5
4
E
A
3
C
2
1
G
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
H
L
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
x
I
-1
-2
-3
-4
K
J
-5
-6
-7
-8
Check Yourself 10
1. Graph the points in a coordinate plane.
a. A(3, 1)
b. B(2, 7)
c. C(3, 1)
d. D(5, 6)
e. E(6, 0)
f. F(4, 3)
g. G(2, 2)
h. H(7, 0)
i. I(3, 2)
j. J(4, 4)
k. K(0, 6)
l. L(0, 0)
5
m. M(2, )
2
3
n. N(6, )
2
1 5
o. O( , )
2 2
y
F
E
G
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
B
C
A
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 D 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2 J
K
I
-3
H
L
-4
-5
-6
-7
M
-8
N
54
Algebra 9
3. The ordered pair (x, y) represents a point in the coordinate plane. Name the quadrant or
axis containing the point for each condition.
a. x > 0 and y > 0
e. x = 0 and y > 0
f. x < 0 and y = 0
g. x = 0 and y = 0
h. x = 0
y
8
7
H
C
D
G
6
5
4
3
E
L
2
N
1
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 F
x
-1
-2
I
-3
M -4
-5
K
A
O
J
-6
-7
-8
Answers
1.
M
C
H E
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
B(2, 6)
C(0, 4)
D(0, 0)
E(3, 3)
F(8, 8)
G(4, 0)
H(7, 3)
I(4, 2)
J(0, 2)
K(2, 2)
L(5, 3)
M(1, 7)
N(2, 8)
5
2
2. A(6, 2)
O
A
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 L 1 2 3 4 5
-1
G
-2
I
-3
F
-4
J
-5
-6
-7
-8
6 7 8 x
N
4.
y
C
D
N
L
F
I
K
3. a. I b. IV c. III d. II
e. positive side of the
y-axis f. negative side
of the x-axis g. origin
h. y-axis
55
EXAMPLE
52
Solution
6a + 3 = 2 3b,
a 2b = 5.
Given y = 2x + 1, find
a. y when x = 3.
b. x when y = 3.
a. If x = 3 then
b. If
y = 2 (3) + 1
y=6+1
y = 7.
y = 3 then
3 = 2x + 1
3 1 = 2x
2 = 2x
1 = x.
We can see that the ordered pairs (3, 7) and (1, 3) are two solutions to y = 2x + 1. However,
notice that when x changes, y also changes. This means that for each different value of x
(or y), y (or x) has a different value. Therefore a linear equation in two variables can have
infinitely many solutions.
EXAMPLE
53
4 = 2 (2) + 4
?
4 = 4 + 4
?
Algebra 9
54
Solution To find a solution, we need to fix one variable and solve the equation for the other variable.
It does not matter which value we choose for the first variable.
Let us begin by choosing x = 1:
x=1
y=1+4
(1, 5) is a solution.
y=5
y=x+4
x
(x, y)
(1, 5)
(2, 6) is a solution.
y=6
(x, y)
(1, 5)
(2, 6)
(x, y)
(1, 5)
(2, 6)
(5, 9)
(5, 9).
y=9
Then choose x = 1:
(x, y)
(1, 5)
(2, 6)
(5, 9)
-1
(-1, 3)
Finally, choose x = 2:
(x, y)
x = 2
(1, 5)
y = (2) + 4
(2, 6)
(5, 9)
-1
(-1, 3)
-2
(-2, 2)
x = 1
y = (1) + 4
(1, 3).
y=3
y=2
(2, 2).
So one answer to the question is {(1, 5), (2, 6), (5, 9), (1, 3), (2, 2)}. Remember that we could
have chosen different values of x or y and found a different answer to the question: there are
infinitely many solutions to this problem.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
57
y
Output values
Input values
y
9
8
7
6
5
4
(-1,3)
3
(-2,2)
2
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -11
(5,9)
(2,6)
(1,5)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
EXAMPLE
55
Solution
Graph y = 2x + 3.
First step:
Let us take fixed values of x to find a set of ordered pairs:
58
x=1
y = 2 (1) + 3
y=5
(x, y)
(1, 5)
x=2
y = 2 (2) + 3
y=7
(2, 7)
x = 1
y = 2 (1) + 3
y=1
-1
(-1, 1)
x = 3
y = 2 (3) + 3
y = 3.
-3
-3
(-3, -3)
Algebra 9
We now have four ordered pairs, although remember we only need two pairs to plot the line.
Second step:
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
(-1,1) 1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
(-1,1) 1
(2,7)
(1,5)
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
-3
(-3,-3)
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
56
EXAMPLE
Third step:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
(-3,-3)
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
(1,5)
y=2x+3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
(2,7)
y=a
(x, y)
-2
(-2, 3)
-1
(-1, 3)
(0, 3)
(1, 3)
(2, 3)
(3, 3)
(6, 3)
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
y=3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
59
57
EXAMPLE
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
(x, y)
-5
(2, -5)
-2
(2, -2)
(2, 0)
(2, 3)
(2, 6)
The graph of x = a (a R) is a
line parallel to the y-axis.
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
x=2
-8
y=0
y
x=0
a
O
EXAMPLE
58
(x, y)
-2
-8
(-2, 8)
-1
-4
(-1, -4)
(0, 0)
(1, 4)
(2, 8)
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
y = 4x
Solution
60
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
x=2
-8
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
59
Solution
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
y=-2x
(x, y)
-3
(-3, 6)
-2
(-2, 4)
-1
(-1, 2)
(0, 0)
-2
(1, -2)
-4
(2, -4)
-6
(3, -6)
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
y=ax
y=ax
We have seen that if we want to draw the graph of a linear equation, it is enough to find
two points which satisfy the equation. In order to make our job easier, we can choose
the points where the line passes through the x-axis and the y-axis. These points are
called the intercepts of the line.
(0,y0)
Ax+By=C
(x0,0)
x
The x-iintercept of a graph is a point of the form (x0, 0) where the graph intersects the
x-axis. To find x0, we substitute y = 0 in the equation. Then we solve the equation for x.
The y-iintercept of a graph is a point of the form (0, y0) where the graph intersects the
y-axis. To find y0, we substitute x = 0 in the equation. Then we solve the equation for y.
61
Definition
intercept method
Plotting the x-intercept and y-intercept of a graph and drawing a line through them is called
the intercept method of graphing a linear equation.
EXAMPLE
60
Solution
Graph y = 2x + 4.
y-iintercept
_______________________
x = 0 y = 2 (0) + 4
y=0+4
y=4
(0, 4)
(0 , y0)
x-iintercept
_______________________
y = 0 0 = 2x + 4
2x = 4
x = 2
(2, 0)
(-2,0)
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
y=2x+4
(0,4)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
(x0 , 0)
EXAMPLE
61
Solution
Graph 3x + 2y = 12.
y-iintercept
_______________________
x = 0 3 (0)+2 y = 12
2y = 12
y=6
(0, 6)
(0 , y0)
x-iintercept
_______________________
y = 0 3 x + 2 0 = 12
3x = 12
x=4
(4, 0)
y
3x+2y=12
8
7
6 (0,6)
5
4
3
2
1
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
(4,0)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
(x0 , 0)
62
Algebra 9
Check Yourself 11
1. Determine whether the given ordered pair satisfies the equation.
a. x + 2y = 5; (3, 1)
c. y
b. y = 4x 7; (1, 3)
3
x 3; (6, 12)
2
d. y
1
x 3; (4, 1)
2
(x, y)
b. y = x 2
x
c. y = 3x
(x, y)
-1
-3
-3
(x, y)
-1
d. y
x
3
e. x + 2y = 3
(x, y)
-5
-3
-1
-3
(x, y)
b. y = 2
c. 2x = 6
d. x + y = 3
e. x + y = 2
f. x y = 2
g. y + 3x = 1
h. 2x + 3y = 6
i. 3x 4y + 24 = 0
4. Graph each equation by using the intercept method.
a. x = 3
b. y = 3
c. 3x = 9
d. x + y = 3
e. x y = 5
f. 3x 2y = 6
g. 3x 4y 12 = 0
h. 5x y = 4
63
system of equations
Any set of equations is called a system of equations.
For example,
2x y = 8
Each equation in a system can have infinitely many solutions when we solve it separately.
However, a system of equations together often has only one common solution. For example, (5, 2)
is the only common solution of the system above:
Check: 2 (5) 2 = 8
and
5+2=7
10 2 = 8
8=8
7 = 7.
TRUE
TRUE
y + x = 3.
Second equation
y-iintercept
x-iintercept
x = 0 y 2 0 = 6
y = 0 0 2x = 6
y = 6
(0, 6)
2x = 6
x = +3
y-iintercept
x = 0 y + 0 = 3
y = 3
(0, 3)
x-iintercept
y = 0 0 + x = 3
x = 3
(3, 0)
(+3, 0)
64
Algebra 9
y+x=-3
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
intersection
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
y - 2x=-6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
We can see that the graphs intersect each other at (1, 4). Let us check whether this point
satisfies both of the equations or not.
First equation
y 2x
4 2 (1)
4 2
6
= 6
= 6
= 6
= 6 TRUE
Second equation
y + x = 3
4 + 1 = 3
3 = 3 TRUE
Therefore the intersection point of these two lines is the solution of the system.
More generally, we know that if an ordered pair satisfies an equation then it must lie on the
graph of that equation.
Since the intersection point of two lines lies on both of the lines, it must satisfy both of the
corresponding equations.
So the intersection point is the solution of the system.
EXAMPLE
62
Solution
4x + 2y = 16
2x 4y = 2
___________________________
x=0
y=0
2 0 4 y = 2
2x = 2
4y = 2
x = 1
1
y=
(1, 0)
2
1
(0, )
2
4x + 2y = 16
___________________________
x=0
y=0
2y = 16
4x = 16
y=8
x=4
(0, 8)
(4, 0)
65
4x+2y=16
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
2x - 4y=-2
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Check:
solution
of the
system
(3, 2)
2x 4y = 2
2 (3) 4 (2) = 2
6 8 = 2
2 = 2
(3,2)
4x + 2y
4 (3) + 2 (2)
12 + 4
TRUE
16
=
=
=
=
16
16
16
16
TRUE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
Number of
solutions
one solution
consistent
and independent
no solution
inconsistent
infinitely many
solutions
consistent and
dependent
Possible graph
System
66
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
63
Solution
4x + 2y = 12.
2x + y = 3
______________________________
x=0
y=0
20 + y = 3
2x + 0 = 3
4 0 + 2y = 12
4x + 2 0 = 12
y=3
2x = 3
2y = 12
4x = 12
y=6
x=3
(0, 3)
x=
x=0
3
2
3
( , 0)
2
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2x+y=3
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
64
Solution
(0, 6)
y=0
(3, 0)
EXAMPLE
4x + 2y = 12
________________________________
4x+2y=12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
6x 12 = 2y.
3x y = 6
______________________________
x=
30 y =
y =
y=
(0, 6)
0
6
6
6
y=
3x 0 =
3x =
x=
(2, 0)
0
6
6
2
6x 12 = 2y
________________________________
x=
6 0 12 =
12 =
6 =
(0, 6)
0
2y
2y
y
y=
6x 12 =
6x =
x=
(2, 0)
0
20
12
2
67
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
-8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
3x - y=6
6x - 12=2y
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
Since these lines are coincident (the same), there are infinitely many solutions.
We can write the equation in the first figure as 2x + y = 4 (equation 1) and the equation in
the second figure as x + y = 3 (equation 2).
We know that multiplying an equality by the same number does not change the equality.
Therefore we can multiply equation 2 by 1 and write x y = 3.
So
3 = x y.
Let us subtract this equation from equation 2:
68
Algebra 9
2x + y = 4
3 = x y
2x + y + 3 = x + y + 4.
________________________________
By removing
,
equation 2:
x+y=3
1+y=3
y=31
y = 2.
and
So (
69
EXAMPLE
65
x y = 1
2x + y = 8
xy=1
+
_______________________
2x + x + y y = 8 + 1
3x = 9
x=3
31=y
2=y
66
5x + 4y = 11.
multiply by 2 to get 4y
5x + 4y = 11
6x 4y = 22
5x + 4y = 11
+
_______________
11x = 33
x=3
Algebra 9
Check:
3 (3) 2 (1) = 11
5 (3) + 4 (1) = 11
9 + 2 = 11
11 = 11
15 4 = 11
TRUE
11 = 11
TRUE
EXAMPLE
67
5x 2y = 4.
multiply by 2
8x + 6y = 34
multiply by 3
15x 6y = 12.
6y = 18;
y = 3.
Check:
8 (2) + 6 (3) = 34
15 (2) 6 (3) = 12
16 + 18 = 34
30 18 = 12
34 = 34
TRUE
12 = 12
TRUE
EXAMPLE
68
x 5y 9 .
6
4
71
Solution In order to clear all the fractions, let us first equalize the denominators in both of the equations:
8 x 9 y 22
12
12
2 x 3y 11
3
4
6
(4)
(3)
(2)
12 x 10 y 27
.
12
12
x
5y
9
1
6
4
(12)
(2)
(3)
Now eliminate x:
12
8 x 9y 22
12
12
12
38x + 9y = 22 24 x 27y = 66
12
12 x 10 y 27
12
12
12
Substitute y =
12
into the first equation:
47
8x 9 (
8x
12
.
47
12
) 22
47
108
22
47
8 x 22
So (
y=
108
47
8x
926
47
463
.
188
463 12
,
) is the solution.
188 47
x + y = 7 (1)
72
So x = y + 3. Now put
and
instead of
73
EXAMPLE
69
2x + 3y = 11.
2x + 3y = 11
31 + 3 = 6
2 1 + 3 3 = 11
3+3=6
6=6
EXAMPLE
70
2 + 9 = 11
TRUE
11 = 11
TRUE
2x 3y = 19.
3 4y
.
3
3 4y
for x in the second equation:
3
Algebra 9
3 4y
) 3 y 19
3
6 8y
3y 19
3
6 8 y 9y
19
3
6 17 y 57
3 4y
:
3
3 4 (3)
3
3 12
3
15
3
x 5.
17 y 51
y 3.
EXAMPLE
71
3 ( x 1) 2 6 2 y
Solve the system 7 x 3y 5
.
2
6
3
Solution
3(x + 1) + 2
3x + 3 + 2
3x
3x
= 6 2y
= 6 2y
= 6 5 2y
= 1 2y
x=
1 2y
3
3
2
6
1 2y
7 (
)
3y 5
3
3
2
6
(2)
(3)
1 2y
14 (
) 9y 5
3
14 28 y 9 y
5
1
3
(3)
14 28 y 27 y
5
3
14 y
5
3
14 y 15
y 1.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
75
1 2y
:
3
x
1 2 (1)
3
1 2
3
3
3
x 1.
Suggested method
3x + y = 8
Substitution
y=2
3x + 2y = 5
Elimination
5x 2y = 7
3.2x + 6.35y = 41.2
Graph on a graphics
calculator or computer
Why?
The value of y is known and can be easily
substituted into the other equation.
2y and 2y are opposites and are easily
eliminated.
The coefficients are decimal numbers, so
other methods may involve complicated
calculations.
Check Yourself 12
1. Use the graphing method to solve each system.
a. x y 3
x y 1
b. x 2 y 5
2 x 3y 3
c. x y 2
x y 4
d. x 4y 2
x y 7
e. x 3y 3
5x y 15
f.
g. 2 x 4y 8
x 4 2 y
h.
i.
76
x y 8
3
11
2
3 x 4 y 2
3x 2 y 2
3x
y 2 3
1
13
2
3 x 2 y 3
5
x 7y 2
2
6
Algebra 9
x 3y 11
b. 2 x y 0
3x 2 y 2
c. 2 x 5 y 12
2 x 6 y 4
e. 3x y 17
3x 2 y 20
f.
5x 7 y 0
5y 7 x 24
g. 3 (2 x 3) 6 y
4 ( x 1) 4 y 2
h.
i.
x 2 y 2
3 2
x 3 2 y
2
3
3
1
2 x 5 y 5
5x 4 y 16
d. 3x 9 5y
4y 8 2 x
x y 6
b. x 3y 0
3x 2 y 11
c. x y 4
x 3y 10
e.
7 x 2 y 1
5x 3y 7
f.
g.
h.
1 3y x 1 15
4 4 2
3x 4 4 y 13
8
8
2
6 x 5 y 5
2 x 3y 25
d. 3x 2 y 14
2 x 3y 5
1
1
1
2 x 3 y 6
2
x 3 y 13
3
2
6
4. Choose a suitable method for solving each system, and explain your decision.
a. 2 x 3y 7
x 2 y 0
b. 7 x 3y 10
2 x 6 y 4
Answers
1. Use
77
1. a.
b.
y
3
2
1
-1
5
2
1
x
1 2 3
-1
d.
c.
5
4
3
y
2
1
x
3
2
7
6
5
4
3
2
1 x
e.
f.
3
2
1
-1
2 3 4
1
-1
-2
-3
-4
2
3
1 2
-1
-3
-7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
(3, 0) is the solution
g.
h.
-6
2
1
-7
1 2 3 4
i.
8
22
3
-2
-5 -4 -3
-1
-1
-2
2 3
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
33
4
2
x
-8 -6
-9
(2, 6) is the solution
35 20
,
)
13 13
48 34
3. a. (2, 4) b. (3, 1) c. (1, 3) d. (4, 1) e. (1, 4) f.(5, 5) g. (1, 1) h. ( ,
)
5
5
4. a. Substitution , because the value of x = 2y in the second equation can be easily substituted
into the other equation.
b. Elimination, because when we multiply the first equation by 2 we get 6y and 6y in the
equations. These can be easily eliminated.
c. Graph on a computer, because the coefficients are large numbers.
78
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
1 .3
a. 2x + 3y = 6
2
(2, )
3
b. x 2y = 5
(2, 3)
c. x 2y = 5
(1, 9)
a. x + y = 13
x y = 5
b. 3x y = 18
2y + x = 6
x y 3
c.
2 3 2
x y
1
3 2 10
b. x y = 4
c. 3x + 6y = 12
d. 2x 5y = 10
x + y = 2
b. x 3y = 5
x + 2y = 10
c. 2x + 3y = 8
x 2y = 3
2
1
5
d. x y
3
2
2
2
x 1 y 14
9
3
9
x + y = 5
b. 2a + 3b = 8
a 2b = 4
c. x = 2y + 5
x = 11 4y
3x 5
d.
y0
4
x 5y 1 0
2 x 3y 10
e.
2
x
6 x 3y 6
2
y
elimination method.
a. x + y = 5
x y = 3
b. 2x y = 15
x y = 6
c. 4x + 3y = 12
2x 4y = 6
d. 3(2x 1) = 5y
7(x + 1) = 4(y + 4)
x y 5
e.
6 6 2
x y 1
9 9 3
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
f.
x 2y
3 4
2x y
2
2
79
Objectives
A. QUADRATIC EQUATIONS
Definition
quadratic equations
A quadratic equation is an equation that can be written in the form ax2 + bx + c = 0, where
a, b and c are real numbers and a 0.
For example,
x2 + 3x = 10, x2 4x + 2 = 0 and x2 = 9 are quadratic equations. 6x = 12 and x = 2 are
not quadratic equations because a = 0.
Sometimes a quadratic equation is called a second degree equation, because the degree of the
polynomial ax2 + bx + c is 2.
When a quadratic equation is written as ax2 + bx + c = 0, we say it is in standard form.
EXAMPLE
72
Determine whether each of the following is a quadratic equation or not. If the equation is
quadratic, write it in standard form.
1
a. x2 + 3x = 0
b. 3x2 2x = 3
c.
x x2 1 0
2
d.
Solution
x2 2 x
0
x
e. (x2 + 1)(x 2) = 0
f.
1
3
x
a. x2 + 3x = 0 is a quadratic equation.
Standard form: x2 + 3x = 0
b. 3x2 2x = 3 is a quadratic equation.
Standard form: 3x2 2x = 3
c.
80
1
x x2 1 0 is a quadratic equation.
2
Standard form: 2x2 + x + 2 = 0
Algebra 9
d.
x2 2 x
0 is not a quadratic equation.
x
1
3 is a quadratic equation.
x
Standard form: x2 3x + 1 = 0
x
The values of x that satisfy a quadratic equation are called the solutions or the roots of the
equation.
We can find the roots of a quadratic equation in four ways: by factoring, by taking a square
root, by completing the square, and by using the quadratic formula. Let us look at each
method in turn.
73
or
x2=0
x=1
or
x = 2.
81
EXAMPLE
74
Solution
b. x2 + x 6 = 0
c. 4x2 9 = 0
a. x2 3x = 0 can be factored as
d. 3x2 + 5x + 2 = 0
x (x 3) = 0, so
x = 0 or x 3 = 0
(x + 3)(x 2) = 0, so
x = 0 or x = 3.
x+3=0
or x 2 = 0
x = 3 or x = 2.
(2x + 3)(2x 3) = 0, so
(3x + 1)(x + 2) = 0, so
2x + 3 = 0 or 2x 3 = 0
x
3
2
or
3x + 1 = 0 or x + 2 = 0
3
x .
2
3 3
The solution set is { , }.
2 2
1
3
or
x 2.
1
}.
3
If x2 = a and a 0 then x = a or
x = a.
Solving quadratic equations using this rule is called using the square root method.
82
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
75
EXAMPLE
76
x 9=0
x2 9 = 0
(x 3) (x + 3) = 0
x2 = 9
x 3 = 0 or x + 3 = 0
x = 9 or x = 9
x = 3 or x = 3.
x=3
Find the solution set S of each equation by using the square root method.
a. x2 = 4
Solution
or x = 3.
b. x2 = 25
c. (x + 1)2 = 4
a. x2 = 4
d. (2x 1)2 = 9
b. x2 = 25
x = 4 or x = 4
x = 25 or x = 25
x = 2 or x = 2
x=5
S = {2, 2}
S = {5, 5}
c. (x + 1)2 = 4
or
x = 5
d. (2x 1)2 = 9
x + 1 = 4 or x + 1 = 4
2x 1 = 9 or (2x 1)2 = 9
x+1=2
2x 1 = 3
x=1
or x + 1 = 2
or x = 3
S = {3, 1}
or 2x 1 = 3
2x = 4
or
2x = 2
x=2
or
x = 1
S = {1, 2}
start
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
1
b )2
2
add
(x
b 2
).
2
result
83
EXAMPLE
77
2
Solution x + 4x + 3 = 0
x2 + 4x = 3
Remember: we must add
the square of half the
coefficient of x to both
sides of an equation to
balance the equality.
x2 4 x (
1
1
4)2 3 ( 4)2
2
2
x2 + 4x + 4 = 3 + 4
(x + 2)2 = 1
x + 2 = 1 or x + 2 = 1
x + 2 = 1 or x + 2 = 1
x = 1 or x = 3
S = {3, 1}
EXAMPLE
78
Solution
2 x2 6 x
x2 3 x
7
=0
2
7
2
7
4
3
7
3
x 3 x ( )2 ( ) 2
2
4 2
3
7 9
( x )2
2
4 4
3
16
4
( x )2
2
4
x
3
4
2
3
2
2
7
2
or
or
or x
3
4 (use the square root method)
2
3
2
2
1
2
1 7
S { , }
2 2
84
Algebra 9
(a 0)
ax + bx = c
x2
b
c
x .
a
a
The coefficient of x2 is now 1, so we can add the square of half of the coefficient of x to both sides:
x2
b
1 b
c
1 b
x ( )2 ( )2
a
2 a
a 2 a
x2
b
b2
b2
c
x 2 2
a
a
4a
4a
(x
b 2 b2 4ac
)
2a
4a 2
b2
c
b2
4ac b 2 4ac
2
)
2
a
4a
4a
4a 2
4a 2
(1)
2a
x
x
Definition
b2 4ac
4a2
or x
(4 a )
b
b 2 4ac
2a
4a2
b
b2 4ac
b
or x
2a
2a
2a
( b 2 4 ac 0)
b 2 4ac
2a
b b2 4ac
b b 2 4ac
.
or x
2a
2a
quadratic formula
If ax2 + bx + c = 0, where a, b and c are real numbers and a 0 then
x
b b2 4ac
.
2a
This formula for the roots of a quadratic equation is called the quadratic formula.
The quantity b2 4ac is called the discriminant of a quadratic equation. It is denoted by
= b2 4ac. We use the discriminant to determine the nature of the roots of the quadratic
equation.
For a quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0:
1. if b2 4ac > 0, there are two unequal real roots.
2. if b2 4ac = 0, there is a double root (i.e. there are two identical roots).
3. if b2 4ac < 0, there is no real solution to the equation.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
85
To solve a quadratic equation by using the quadratic formula, follow the steps:
1. Write the equation in standard form (ax2 + bx + c = 0).
2. Identify a, b and c.
3. Evaluate the discriminant, = b2 4ac.
If > 0, the equation has two real roots.
If = 0, the equation has one double root.
If < 0, the equation has no real solution.
4. If 0, solve the equation using the quadratic formula
x
EXAMPLE
79
b b2 4ac
.
2a
2
Solution x 2x 2 = 0 can be compared to
ax2 + bx + c = 0 a = 1
b = 2
c = 2.
Since b 4ac > 0, there are two real roots which we can find using the quadratic formula:
x
b b2 4ac (2) 12 2 2 3
1 3.
2a
2 1
2
EXAMPLE
80
2
Solution 9x 30x + 25 = 0 a = 9, b = 30 and c = 25.
b b2 4ac (30) 0 30 5
2a
29
18 3
5
The solution set is { }.
3
86
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
81
2
Solution 2x + 3x + 4 = 0 a = 2, b = 3 and c = 4.
Check Yourself 13
1. Solve the equations by factoring.
a. x2 6x = 0
b. x2 + 5x = 0
c. x2 + 5x + 6 = 0
d. x2 x 12 = 0
e. 9x2 16 = 0
f. 4x2 25 = 0
g. 2x2 5x 3 = 0
2. Solve the equations using the square root method.
a. x2 = 25
b. (x 1)2 = 4
c. (2x + 3)2 = 9
b. x2 + 2x 3 = 0
d. 9x2 + 6x 24 = 0
e. x2 4x 32 = 0
c. 4x2 4x 8 = 0
b. x2 + x 20 = 0
c. x2 + 2x 5 = 0
d. 2x2 7x + 4 = 0
e. 3x2 + 8x 2 = 0
f. 4x2 8x 3 = 0
Answers
5 5
1
4 4
1. a. {0, 6} b. {5, 0} c. {3, 2} d. {3, 4} e. { , } f. { , } g. { , 3}
3 3
2 2
2
9 11
2. a. {5, 5} b. {1, 3} c. {3, 0} d. { ,
}
5 5
4
} e. {4, 8}
3
4. a. {2, 7} b. {5, 4} c. {1 6, 6 1} d. {7 17 , 7 17 } e. { 4 22 , 4 22 }
4
4
3
3
2 7 2 7
f. {
,
}
2
2
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
87
Objectives
After studying this section you will be able to use the algebra you have learned to solve
written problems involving numbers, fractions, ages, work, percentages, interest, mixtures
and motion.
In section 1.1 we learned how to translate verbal phrases into algebraic expressions.
In this section we will look at how to solve written problems using algebra.
EXAMPLE
82
The sum of two numbers is 96. The bigger number is twice as large as the smaller number.
Find the numbers.
1st
2nd
2x
1st
2nd
3rd
a+1
a+2
3x = 96
x=
EXAMPLE
83
96
32. So the numbers are 32 and 2 32 = 64.
3
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
84
Solution
The sum of four even consecutive integers is 92. Find the numbers.
x + (x + 2) + (x + 4) + (x + 6) = 92
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
4x + 12 = 92
x+2
x+4
x+6
4x = 80
x = 20
So the integers are 20, 22, 24, and 26.
EXAMPLE
85
Solution
The sum of three numbers is 97. The third number is twice as large as the second. The
second number is one more than twice the first number. Find the numbers.
x + (2x + 1) + 2 (2x + 1) = 87
1st
2nd
3rd
x + 2x + 1 + 4x + 2 = 87
2x+1
2 (2x+1)
7x + 3 = 87
7x = 87 3
7x = 84
x = 12
Therefore the numbers are 12, 25 and 50.
EXAMPLE
86
An electrician cuts a 53 meter-long piece of wire into three pieces, such that the longest piece
is four times as long as the shortest piece and the middle-sized piece is three meters shorter
than twice the length of the shortest piece. Find the length of each piece.
53 m
7x 3 = 53
7x = 53 + 3
7x = 56
xm
(2x - 3) m
4x m
x=8
Therefore the pieces are 8 m, 13 m and 32 m long.
EXAMPLE
87
If 13 is added to four times a number, the result is 61. Find the number.
Solution
4x
4x + 3
(13 is added)
4x + 13 = 61 (result is 61)
4x = 48 x = 12
89
EXAMPLE
88
1
of a water tank, the tank is half full. Find the volume of the
3
tank.
Solution
x
x
10
3
2
10
x
x
2
3
(3)
EXAMPLE
89
Solution
90
10
x 60 liters
(2)
x
6
The sum of the denominator and the numerator of a fraction is 47. If 2 is subtracted from
2
the denominator and 5 is added to the numerator, the value of the fraction is . Find the
3
fraction.
Let the fraction be
Also,
EXAMPLE
10
3x 2x
6
x
. Then x + y = 47 y 47 x
y
x 5
2
x 5
47 x 2 3
45 x
2
3
3x 15 90 2 x
3 x 2 x 90 15
x 15
x
x
.
y 47 x
3 ( x 5) 2 (45 x)
5 x 75
x
x
15
15
15
. So the fraction is
.
32
y 47 x 47 15 32
The sum of the digits of a two-digit number is 12. If the digits are reversed, the new number
is 36 less than the original number. Find the number.
10a + b (10b + a) = 36
a + b = 12
10a + 2 10b a = 36
9a 9b = 36
and
ab=4
+
______________
2a = 16
9(a b) = 36
a = 8.
ab=4
Substituting a = 8 into the first equation, we get
8 + b = 12 b = 4. So the original number is 84.
90
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
91
There are 25 students in a class. The number of boys is three more than the number of girls.
Find the number of girls and boys in the class.
Solution
First way
Second way
girls
boys
girls
boys
25 x
y + x = 25
25 x = x + 3
yx=3
+
______________
25 3 = 2x
22 = 2x
2y = 28
x = 11
y = 14,
92
Solution
Second way
dimes
nickels
dimes
nickels
42 x
10 x + 5 (42 x) = 3 100
x + y = 42
10x + 5y = 300
5x = 300 210
2x + y = 60
5x = 90
x + y = 42
x = 18
So I have 18 dimes and 42 18 = 24
nickels.
93
(divide by 5)
x = 18
EXAMPLE
x = 25 14 = 11
The sum of half of a number and one-third of another number is 22. The difference of half
of the second number and one sixth of the first number is 11. Find the numbers.
22
2
3
(3)
3x 2y
22
6
3 x 2 y 6 22 132
3y x
11
6
3 y x 6 11 66
(2)
y
x
11
2
6
(3)
(1)
91
3x + 2y = 132
9y 3x = 198
+
_______________
3x + 2 30 = 132
11y = 330
y = 30
3x = 132 60
3x = 72
x = 24.
Check Yourself 14
1. Four times a number decreased by 5 is 67. Find the number.
2. Three times a number increased by 12 is equal to five times the number decreased by 18. Find
the number.
3. The sum of a number and 13 is 29. Find the number.
4. The sum of twice a number and 21 is 43. Find the number.
5. The sum of two consecutive integers is 95. Find the numbers.
6. The sum of four consecutive integers is equal to twice the smallest integer increased by
48. Find the biggest number.
7. The sum of two numbers is 25 and their difference is 17. Find the numbers.
8. The sum of two numbers is 80. The larger number is five more than twice the smaller
number. Find the numbers.
9. One number is seven times another number. The larger number is 42 more than the
smaller number. Find the numbers.
10.In an election, the winner had 180 more votes than the loser. The total number of votes
was 2080. Find the number of votes cast for each candidate.
11.A concert was held in a school. Student tickets cost $5 and regular tickets cost $8. The
school sold 284 tickets for $1600. Find the number of student tickets and the number of
regular tickets sold.
12.
5
2
of a pool was filled with water. After pouring out
of the amount of water in the
7
5
pool, 62 liters of water was needed to fill the pool completely. Find the amount of water
Answers
1. 18 2. 15 3. 42 4. 11 5. {47, 48} 6. 24 7. {4, 21} 8. {25, 55} 9. {7, 49} 10. {1130, 950}
11. The school sold 224 student tickets and 60 regular tickets. 12. 70 13.
92
5
11
Algebra 9
2. Age Problems
We can use algebra to solve problems about peoples ages. When solving problems like this,
it is useful to remember the following things:
1. In t years, everyone will be t years older.
2. t years ago, everyone was t years younger.
3. The difference between the ages of two people is always constant.
4. The sum of the ages of n people will increase by nt years in t years.
For example, Radik is 13 and his younger brother Almaz is 8 years old.
1. In three years time, Radik will be 13 + 3 years old, and Almaz will be 8 + 3 years old.
2. Two years ago, Radik was 13 2 years old, and Almaz was 8 2 years old.
3. The difference between the brothers ages now is 13 8 = 5 years. In twenty years time
the difference will be 33 28 = 5 years: the difference does not change.
4. The sum of the brothers ages is 13 + 8 = 21. In twenty years time the sum will be
33 + 28 = 61.
This is the same as 21 + nt = 21 + (2 20) = 21 + 40 = 61.
EXAMPLE
94
A mother is 38 years old and her daughter is 13 years old. In how many years will the
mother be twice as old as her daughter?
mother
daughter
now
38
13
x years
later
38 + x
13 + x
x = 12 years later.
So the answer is in 12 years.
EXAMPLE
95
Solution
The sum of the ages of two children is 30. Five years ago, one child was six years older than
the other child. Find their ages now.
first child
_____________
x
second child
______________
y
x + y = 30
xy=6
(the difference does not change)
+
________________
2x = 36
x = 18
y = 30 18 = 12
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
93
EXAMPLE
96
Solution
The sum of the ages of three children is 27. In how many years will the sum of their ages be 63?
x + y + z = 27
(x + t) + (y + t) + (z + t) = 63
x + y + z + 3t = 63
27
now
child 1
child 2
child 3
t years
later
x+t
y+t
z+t
27 + 3t = 63
3t = 63 27
3t = 36
t = 12
So the answer is in 12 years.
EXAMPLE
97
Solution
A mother has three children. The middle child is two years older than the youngest child, and
the oldest child is two years older than the middle child. The mothers age now is twice the
sum of the ages of her children. If the mother is 30 years old now, find her age when her
oldest child was born.
first
child
________
x+4
second child
____________
x+2
2 (x + x + 2 + x + 4)
2 (3x + 6)
3x + 6
3x
x
third
child
_________
x
=
=
=
=
=
30
30
15
9
3
So the oldest child is seven years old now. Therefore he/she was born seven years ago. Thus,
the mother was 30 7 = 23 years old.
EXAMPLE
94
98
A father has two sons. The fathers age now is ten times the difference of the sons ages. Three
years ago, the fathers age was three times the sum of his sons ages. If the father is 30 now,
how old are his sons?
Algebra 9
Solution
father
first son
second son
now
30
three
years ago
27
x3
y3
xy=3
10(x y) = 30
xy=3
x + y = 15
+
________________
2x = 18
x=9
y=6
Check Yourself 15
1. Kerem is three times as old as Semih. In four years, he will be twice as old as Semih. How
old are Kerem and Semih?
2
2. Murats age is four less than twice Kemals age. In ten years, Kemals age will be
of
3
Murats age. How old are Murat and Kemal?
3. The sum of Kerims age and twice Serdars age is 34. The difference between Serdars age
and twice Kerims age is 7. How old are Kerim and Serdar?
4. In 1990, Aye was three times as old as her son. That year the difference of their ages was
22 years. In what year was each born?
5. Selim is six, Salih is ten and mer is thirteen years old. How old will Selim, Salih and
mer be in eight years?
6. A fathers age is 10 more than the sum of the ages of his two sons. Eight years ago his age
was three times the sum of the ages of his sons. How old is the father now?
7. The sum of the ages of Fatma and Levent is 46. If we subtract 2 from three times Levents
age we get Fatmas age. How old are Fatma and Levent?
8. Five years ago, Ahmet was three years older than twice Fatihs age. In seven years Ahmets
age will be 9 less than two times Fatihs age. How old are Ahmet and Fatih?
Answers
1. Semih: 4 2. Kemal: 18 3. Kerim: 4 4. Aye: 1957 5. Selim: 14
7. Levent: 12 8. Ahmet: 20 Kerem: 12 Murta: 32 Serdar: 15
Her Son: 1979
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
Salih: 18
Fatma: 34
Fatih: 11
6. Father: 35
mer: 21
95
3. Work Problems
We can use algebra to calculate how long it takes for a number of workers to complete a particular job. For example, we might want to know how long it will take for six men to build a
wall. In problems like this, we suppose that each man works at the same speed or rate, for
example, that each man alone can build 5m2 of wall in one day.
We will use the formula
(work rate) (working time) = (amount of work done)
or r t = w .
For example, in the problem above, the formula for six men would use
r = 5m2 6 = 30m2 of wall
t = number of days, and
w = area of wall produced.
The following calculations are useful for solving work problems.
1. If a number of workers can complete a job in t hours, then the same number of workers
1
can complete
of the job in one hour.
t
2. Suppose two workers can complete a job in x and y hours respectively. If they work
1 1 1
together, they will complete the job in t hours, where t is given by
.
x y t
EXAMPLE
99
Solution
Ahmet can wash the family car in 45 minutes. Mehmet can wash it in 30 minutes. How long
will it take them to wash the car if they work together?
1
1
t
t 1
45
30
(2)
rate
time
work
Ahmet
1
45
1
t
45
Mehmet
1
30
1
t
30
(3)
2t 3t
1
90
5t 90
t 18 minutes.
30 45 t
90 t
(3)
96
90
18.
5
(2)
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
100 Mustafa can paint a house in eighteen hours. Murat can paint the same house in twelve
hours. If Mustafa works alone for six hours and then stops, how long will it take Murat to
finish the job?
Solution
First way:
1
1
.6
. x 1
18
12
1
x
1
3 12
rate
time
work
Mustafa
1
18
1
6
18
Murat
1
12
1
x
12
(4)
4x
1
12
4 x 12
x 8 hours
Second way: Since Mustafa can paint a house in 18 hours, after six hours he will have fin1 2
ished one third of the house. So 1
of the job will remain.
3 3
Murat can paint the whole house in 12 hours, so he can complete painting two thirds of the
2
house in 12 8 hours.
3
EXAMPLE
101 Two pipes can fill a pool in six hours. The larger pipe can fill the pool twice as fast as the
smaller one. How long does it take the smaller pipe to fill the pool alone?
Solution
6 6
1
x 2x
6 3
1
x x
rate
time
work
9
1
x
pipe A
1
x
6
x
x 9 hours
pipe B
1
2x
6
2x
Alternatively,
1
1
1
2 1 1
3
1
2 x 18
x 2x 6
2x
6
2x 6
(2)
x 9 hours.
EXAMPLE
102 Two pipes A and B can fill a storage tank in four and six hours respectively. A drain C can
empty the full tank in three hours. How long will it take to fill the tank if both pipes and the
drain are open?
Solution
1
1
1
1
324 1
1
1
x 12 hours
4
6
3
x
12
x
12 x
(3)
(2)
(4)
97
EXAMPLE
103 Two pipes A and B can fill an empty pool in six and eight hours respectively. A drain C can
empty the full pool in twelve hours. For two hours, the pipes and the drain are left open.
Then pipe A and pipe B are closed. How long will it take the drain C to empty the water in
the pool?
Solution
1
1
1
1
1
1
2 2
2
3
4
6
6
8
12
(4)
(3)
(2)
432
5
12
12
rate
time
part of work
pipe A
1
6
2h
1
2
6
pipe B
1
8
2h
1
2
8
drain C
1
12
2h
1
2
12
1
5
t
12
12
t 5 hours.
EXAMPLE
104 Erkin can plough a garden in 20 hours and Asm can do the same job in 32 hours. They work
together for eight hours, then Asm stops working. How long will it take Erkin to finish the job?
Solution
8x
8
1
20
32
4
EXAMPLE
8x
1
1
20
4
8x 3
4
20
5
8 x 15
x 7 hours
rate
time
work
Erkin
1
20
8+x
8x
20
Asm
1
32
8
32
105 In the storage tank1shown in the figure, the height of drain C from the
98
Algebra 9
Solution
rate
time for
1/3
time for
2/3
work for
1/3
work for
2/3
pipe A
1
18
x
18
y
18
pipe B
1
24
x
24
y
24
drain C
1
36
y
36
Notice that the drain C only affects the rate of work when the tank is over one-third full. So
there are two rates of work: one rate to fill one-third of the tank, and another rate to fill the
other two-thirds of the tank. It takes
x
x
1
18 24 3
(4)
4 x 3x 1
72
3
7 x 24
24
hours to fill one-third of the storage
7
24
(3)
Then, it takes
y
y
y
2
18 24 36 3
(4)
(3)
4y 3y 2 y 2
72
3
5 y 48
48
hours
5
24
(2)
to fill the storage tank if pipes A and B and the drain C are working.
Therefore the total time is
7
5
35
35
(5)
hours, or 13
1
hours.
35
(7)
Check Yourself 16
1. Emine can do a job in six hours and Aye can do the same job in three hours. How long
will it take them to do the job if they work together?
2. One printer can print a collection of documents in 45 minutes and another printer can
print them in 30 minutes. How long will it take them to print the documents if they work
together?
3. Hseyin can do a job in four days, brahim can do it in eight days, and Hasan can do it in
six days. Hseyin and brahim work together until they finish half of the job. Then Hasan
comes to help them. How long does the whole job take?
4. Yunus and Yusuf can do a job in eight days. Yusuf and Ali can do it in six days. Ali and
Yunus can do it in twelve days. How long will take Yunus, Yusuf and Ali to do the job if
they all work together?
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
99
5. Murat and Mustafa can do a job together in fifteen days. After they have worked together
for five days, Mustafa leaves the job. Murat completes the job in sixteen days. How long
would it take Mustafa to do the job alone?
6. Pipe A can fill a storage tank in seven hours and pipe B can fill it in nine hours. How long
will it take them to fill the tank if they work together?
7. Pipe A can fill two-thirds of a pool in four hours. Pipe B can fill a quarter of the pool in
four hours. Drain C at the bottom of the pool can empty the full pool in twenty hours.
How long will it take to fill the empty pool if both pipes and the drain are working?
8. Ferhat can work twice as fast as Barbaros. Barbaros can work three times as fast as Tuncer.
Working together, they can finish a job in four days. How long would it take Ferhat to do
the job alone?
Answers
1. 2 hours 2. 18 minutes 3.
8. 6 days
88
16
63
240
days 4.
days 5. 40 days 6.
days 7.
hours
39
3
16
43
1. b% =
b
100
2. b% of a number x is x
EXAMPLE
b
100 b
x(
).
100
100
b
100 b
x(
).
100
100
Solution
100
b
.
100
35
210
100
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
107 x% of 40 is 8. Find x.
Solution
x
10 0
80
20
4
8
1
1
1 20 1 20
.
so 8 is
of 40. Also,
40 5
5
5 20 5 100
Solution
75
27
x
100
x 36
EXAMPLE
Solution
EXAMPLE
12
x
18
100
3
x 150
110 The number of workers in a factory increases from 525 to 550. Find the percentage increase
in the number of workers.
Solution
The increase is 550 525 = 25 workers. So the problem is: what percent of 525 is 25?
21
25 525
x
100
100
4.76
21
111 The price of a car goes up by 3%, which is $420. What is the new price of the car?
Solution
3
100
420 100
14000
3
111 80% of the students in a class pass a math exam. If six students failed the exam, find the
number of students in the class.
Solution
20
6 x 30
100
101
EXAMPLE
112 A shopkeeper bought a jacket and a suit from a wholesaler. He then sold the jacket for $55,
which was 25% more than the wholesale price. He sold the suit for $64, which was 20% less
than the wholesale price. How much money did the shopkeeper lose or earn?
Solution
125
55 x = 44, so the shopkeeper bought the jacket for $44 and earned $11.
x
100
4
80
64 x 80. Therefore the shopkeeper lost 80 64 = $16.
x
10 0
5
b. Interest Problems
When you lend money for a certain period of time to a bank, you expect to be rewarded by
eventually getting your money back, plus an extra amount called interest.
Similarly, if you borrow money from a bank, you must pay back the original sum, plus interest.
We use the following variables for solving interest problems:
i = interest
p = principal (the sum of money borrowed or invested)
r = rate of interest (per year)
t = term of the investment, in years (the period of time for which the sum of money is to be
borrowed or invested).
We can use these variables to make the following formulas:
annual interest: i =
daily interest: i =
EXAMPLE
p r t
100
pr t
100 360
monthly interest: i =
pr t
100 12
total amount: A = p + i
113 Selin earned $40 in simple interest for one year with an annual interest rate of 5%. What was
her principal?
Solution
102
pr t
100
40
p 5 t
100
20
p 40 20
p $800
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
114 Esras investment of $950 earned $57 in three months. What was the monthly interest rate?
Solution
57
950 r 3
100 12
57 10 0 12
24.
95 0 3
115 A certain amount of money was invested with an annual interest rate of 25%. After one year,
the amount increased to $2750. What was the initial principal?
Solution
p i 2750
p 25 1
2750
100
125 p
2750
100
p $2200
Check Yourself 17
1. Figens bank pays 8% monthly simple interest on her investment of $350. How much
interest will the account earn in six months?
2. Tolgas investment of $1800 earned $576 in annual simple interest. What was the annual interest rate?
3. Mahmut invested a sum of money. After four years, Mahmuts investment had doubled.
What was the annual simple interest rate?
Answers
1. $14
2. 32%
3. 25%
5. Mixture Problems
Chemists and pharmacists sometimes need to mix or change chemical solutions. A solution
is a mixture of a particular ingredient (for example, sugar or acid) with a liquid (for example,
water). We usually express the amount of the ingredient as a percentage of the total solution.
For example, consider a solution of sugar in water which has a sugar concentration of 20%.
We mean that 100 units of this solution contains 20 units of sugar and 80 units of water.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
103
EXAMPLE
116 A pharmacist has 80 mL of an acid solution which contains 20% acid. How much acid should
she add to the solution to make a 60% acid solution?
Solution
amount of
solution
% of acid
80 mL
20%
80 + x
60%
amount of acid
80
20
= 16 mL
100
16 + x
So
60
16 x
100 80 x
240 3 x 80 5 x
160 2 x
x 80 mL.
117 64 L of a salt solution contains 25% salt. How much water should be evaporated to make a
32% salt solution?
Solution
25
16 L (64 16 = 48 L of water).
100
If we evaporate some water the amount of salt does not change:
32
16
100 64 x
64 x 50
x 14 L.
50
Solution
70
14 L of alcohol
100
80
48 L of alcohol
second solution : 60
100
After mixing, the new amounts are
first solution : 20
62
77.5%.
80
4
104
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
119 A chemist has two salt solutions containing 60% salt and 40% salt respectively. She wants to
produce 50 L of solution containing 46% salt. How much of each original solution should she
mix?
Solution
Thus,
amount of
solution (L)
first solution
40
second solution
60
50 x
new solution
46
50
23
amount of
salt (L)
40
x
100
60
(50 x)
100
46
50
100
40
60
46
x
(50 x)
50
100
100
100
2
3
23 5
x (50 x)
5
5
5
2 x 150 3 x 115 x 150 15 35 L.
So the chemist should mix 35 L of the first solution with 15 L of the second solution.
Check Yourself 18
1. Sabri added 15 L of 40% alcohol solution to 85 L of a 60% alcohol solution. What is the
alcohol concentration of the new solution?
2. How many liters of acid should be added to 60 L of a 25% acid solution in order to produce a 40 % acid solution?
3. A chemist has 30 g of a 10% salt solution. He wants to increase the salt content to 20%.
How much water does he need to evaporate?
4. A chemist has a 75% acid solution and a 25% acid solution. He wants to produce 80 L of
a 47.5% acid solution. How much of each original solution should he mix?
Answers
1. 57% 2. 15 L 3. 15 L 4. 25 L of the 75% solution and 55 L of the 25% solution.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
105
6. Motion Problems
If an object does not change its speed during motion, then it is said to be in uniform motion.
Uniform motion problems are sometimes given in math and physics.
Drawing a simple sketch and making a table are used for solving uniform motion problems.
We use the formula
distance = rate time (d = r t)
EXAMPLE
120 A bus leaves a city travelling at a speed of 60 km/h. Two hours later, a second bus leaves from
the same place, and drives along the same road at 90 km/h. How long will it take for the
second bus to catch up with the first bus?
Solution
The diagram shows the situation after two hours. The city is at point A.
r2=90 km/h
r1=60 km/h
d1
d2
First way:
In two hours, the first bus will have traveled d1 = r1 t1 d1 = 60 2 = 120 km.
When the second bus meets the first bus, the first bus will have traveled d1 + d2 km.
We can write: 120 + r1 t = r2 t 120 + 60 t
= 90 t
120 = 30t
t = 4.
So the buses will meet after four hours.
Second way: 60 (t + 2) = 90 t
60 t + 120 = 90t
120 = 30t
t=4h
EXAMPLE
rate
time
distance
first bus
60 km/h
t+2
60 (t + 2)
second bus
90 km/h
90 t
121 Hakan walks 3 km/h faster than Emre. They leave school walking in opposite directions. After
2.5 hours, they are 30 km apart. How fast do Hakan and Emre walk?
Solution
Since they walk in opposite directions, 30 km is the sum of the distances they cover in 2.5 hours.
rate
106
time
distance
Hakan
r+3
2.5
(2.5) (r + 3)
Emre
2.5
(2.5) r
r+3
S
Hakan
30 km
Emre
Algebra 9
30
300
= 12
2r + 3 =
2.5
25
9
4.5 km/ h.
2
Therefore, Hakan walks at 4.5 + 3 = 7.5 km/h, and Emre walks at 4.5 km/h.
EXAMPLE
122 A courier delivered a parcel to a house and returned immediately. On the way to the house, he
drove at 60 km/h. On the return journey, he drove at 50 km/h. The journey to the house was
18 minutes shorter than the return journey. How far was the house from the couriers office?
Solution
house
office
65 km/h
rate
going
60 km/h
return
50 km/h
time
18
60
t
distance
60( t
18
)
60
50 t
50 km/h
60( t
60t 60
18
) 50 t
60
18
50t
60
10t 18
t 1.8 h
Check Yourself 19
1. A bus travels at 90 km/h. How far will it have traveled after 210 minutes?
2. Two motorcyclists organize a race. The first cyclist rides at 210 km/h and the second
cyclist rides at 180 km/h. The slower motorcyclist starts the race thirty minutes before the
faster one. How long will it take the faster motorcyclist to catch up with the
slower one?
3. Two cities A and B are connected by a road. A car leaves city A and travels towards city B
at 90 km/h. At the same time, another car leaves city B and travels towards city A at 70
km/h. The cars pass each other after seven hours. How long is the road from A to B?
4. Istanbul is 260 km from Edirne. Ahmet leaves Istanbul at 10 a.m. and drives at 50 km/h
towards Edirne. On the same day, Mehmet leaves Edirne at 11 a.m. and drives along the
same road towards Istanbul at 55 km/h. At what time will Ahmet and Mehmet pass each other?
Answers
1. 315 km 2. 3 hours 3. 1120 km 4. 1 p.m.
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
107
EXERCISES
1 .4
a. x 4 = 7
a. x + 2 > 5
b. x 3 < 1
b. 3x 4 = 2
c. 1 x 4
d. 2x + 1 7
c. 2 (2x 2) = x + 4
e. 2x + 3 7
f. 3x + 1 < 10
d. 3 (5x 1) + 4 = 13
g. 3 (x 8) 5x 17
e. 3 (2x + 3) 5 (x 3) = 2 (1 + x) + 19
h.
3
3
( x 5) x x
2
2
i.
x 1 x 2
x
2
2
3
6
j.
x 3 2x 1 x 3
1
2
4
8
k.
4( x 1) 3( x 3) x 2
2
3
4
12
3x 4 2 x 1 x
4
3
12
1
3
x
b.
3
1
3
x
c.
15
4
3
p. 3x 1 < 5 and 2x + 3 5
3
2x 1
x
x1
2
x
1
x 1 x 1 x 1
9
x x2
g.
2
x
x 9
x
h. 1
108
e. 6
f.
n. 6 < 3 (x + 1) < 6
x 1 x 2 x 3 1
2
3
4
12
d.
l. 6 < 2x < 12
x
m. 3 < < 2
3
1
2
2
x
2
2
b. x + 2y = 5
xy=3
3x y = 1
c. 3x + 3y = 6
x+y=2
d.
2x + y = 4
6x + 3y = 15
Algebra 9
b. 3x 4y = 0
3x y = 8
3x + 2y = 2
c.
3y 4x = 7
x 2y
2
3
x y 1
2 3 6
d.
2x y
1
2
a. x 3y = 2
b. 3x + 2y = 8
x + y = 10
x 2y = 0
x 2 y 1
3
2
c. x 3
y 2x + 5
x + 2y < 8
d. 4x + 3y > 0
3x 2y 6
b. x2 + 2x 8 = 0
c. x2 + 5x + 4 = 0
d. x2 10x + 16 = 0
y = 4x 6
(1, 2)
b. 2x y 5
(5, 8)
c. 3x + 2y 3
(4, 3)
5x 3y
2
6
xy2
b. 2x y > 5
d. x = 3y 4
x 1 4 y
2
3
d.
a. x + y > 3
x y 5
3 2 6
c.
(2, 3)
a. (x 3)2 = 25
b. (3x 1)2 = 49
c. x2 + 7x = 0
d. x2 6x 27 = 0
e. x2 3x + 1 = 0
f. 2x2 + 5x 4 = 0
g. 3x2 + 6x 5 = 0
h. 4x2 2x 3 = 0
b. 2x + y 5
c. 3x + 2y 6
d. x 3y + 5
e. 6x + 4y 10
Equations, Inequalities and Systems
109
2
of a wire is cut, the midpoint of the wire
7
moves 10 cm. Find the length of the wire.
14. If
Algebra 8
1A
1. Solve 3x 4 = 2 (x + 1).
A) 2
B) 5
C) 6
D) 8
6. Solve 2
A) 1
1
1
1
x
1.
B)
1
2
C)
1
2
D)
2
3
C)
1
2
D)
2
3
2. Solve 3 (x 1) 2x = 2x + 3.
A) 0
B) 2
C) 4
D) 6
2
2 3 4
7. Solve .
3 x 3
x
A) 1
3. Solve
5x 4
3.
2
A) 0
B) 2
C) 4
B)
1
2
D) 6
4. Solve 2 x
C) 4
D) 4
1
1
x .
2
2
B)
A) 1
1
2
C)
2
3
D) 0
9. Solve
A)
5. Solve
B) 2
2x 1 x 3 1
.
2
3
6
A) 1
Chapter Review Test 1A
B)
1
2
2
3
10. Solve
C)
1
3
D)
1
6
A) 0
2x
17
x2
.
x2
x
3
B)
3
2
1
2
D) 1
C) 1
D)
C)
2x
x1
1 x
.
3
3
B) 2
111
B) x > 3
C) x 3
D) x > 6
5 2x 3 < 5?
A) 4
B) x
1
2
x3
.
2
C) x
1
2
D) x
1
2
2 x 3 12 2 x
.
5
4
B) 3
C) 2
D) 1
2x 3 x 5
.
the inequality
3
4
B) 3
A) 6
112
B) 4
C) 3
D) 2
B) 36
C) 24
D) 26
C) 4
D) 6
A) 9
C) 3
B) 8
C) 7
D) 5
3 2x + 6 < 12?
B) 2
3x 3
6.
2
x + 3 3x 5 x + 11?
D) 1
x 1 7 < 2x + 5.
A) 2
C) 2
A) 4
B) 3
D) 4
A)
1
2
B)
1
4
C)
5
6
D)
5
14
Algebra 9
1B
B) (2, 2)
2x + 3y = 10
6. Given
, find (x, y).
3x + 2y = 5
C) (3, 1)
D) (3, 0)
A) (1, 4)
B) (1, 4)
C) (4, 1)
D) (1, 4)
x 2y = 5
2
-3
A) (3, 1)
B) (0, 4)
C) (3, 1)
D) (6, 1)
A) x + y = 6
B) 2x + 3y = 6
C) 2x 3y = 6
D) x + 2y = 3
B) 28
C) 36
D) 42
x + 2y = 7
3. Given
, find x.
xy=4
A) 5
B) 3
C) 2
D) 2
4x + 7y =13
4. Given
, find x + y.
A)
x 2y = 2
A) 2
B) 3
C) 4
C) 3
B)
3
7
C)
1
7
D)
3
2
xy=4
, find x y.
2
x y = 24
10. Given
x + 2y = 3
B) 2
5
2
D) 5
2x + y = 7
5. Given
, find x y.
A) 1
1 1
x y 4
9.
is given. Find y.
3 2 5
x y
D) 4
A) 96
B) 48
C) 32
D) 5
113
B) 6
C) 8
D) 10
xy0 ?
A)
B)
y
y
y=x
y=x
B) II
C) III
D) IV
C)
y=x
y=x
D)
y=x
y=x
y=x
y=x
B) y 2
C) y > 2
D) y < 2
shaded region?
y
-3
3
-2
3
A) y x 3
2
3
B) y x 3
2
C) y 3x + 2
D) y
114
2
x3
3
A)
x0
y0
x2
y 3
B)
x0
y0
x2
y 3
C)
x0
y0
x2
y 3
D)
x0
y0
x2
y 3
Algebra 9
1C
B) 12
C) 8
D) 12
A) x2 + 3x + 1 = 0
B)
3x
x2 2 0
1
C) x 0
x
A) 1
B) 1
C) 2
D) 1 2
D)
x 3x
0
x
B) {0, 2}
C) {0, 2}
D) {2, 4}
4 4
B) { , }
3 3
3 3
C) { , }
4 4
D) {
16 16
,
}
9
9
8. x y = x + y = 11 is given. What is x?
A) 4
m
9. If
m
B) 6
3
11
n
3
5
n
A) 0
C) 16
D) 36
then find m + n.
B) 2
C) 4
D) 9
3 1
B) { , }
2 2
2 1
C) { , }
3 2
1 2
D) { , }
2 3
10. Find y if (
A) 2
2x 3 2
4x y 2
) (
) 0.
4
3
B) 4
C) 6
D) 8
115
B) 34
C) 35
D) 36
1
. When 5 is subtracted
3
from both numerator and the denominator, its
1
value is
. Find the value of the denominator.
13
A) 7
B) 11
C) 13
D) 18
B) 5
C) 7
D) 8
B) 21
C) 25
D) 31
B) 5
C) 8
D) 11
B) 18
C) 24
D) 28
B) 5
C) 7
D) 9
B) 10
C) 12
D) 27
B) 24
C) 30
D) 32
B) 19
C) 23
D) 27
Algebra 9
1D
A) 9
B)
15
2
C)
1
9
D)
1
6
A)
3
4
B) 14
C) 7
D) 24
B) 9
C) 4
D) 3
B) 8
C) 10
D) 6
B) 15
C)
1
30
D)
1
15
B) 425 km
C) 75 km
D) 35 km
B) 6
C) 12
D) 24
B) 8
C) 12
D) 18
117
A) 32
B) 36
C) 40
A) 35%
B) 40%
C) 45%
D) 55%
D) 42
B) 16%
C) 18%
D) 32%
B) 40%
C) 100%
D) 60%
B) 40%
C) 50%
D) 60%
B) 46
C) 54
D) 69
B) 25%
C) 75%
D) 50%
B) $4800
C) $4600
D) $4200
Algebra 9
angle
An angle is the union of two rays which have a common endpoint.
The angle formed by the rays [OA and [OB is called angle AOB or angle BOA. [OA and [OB are
called the sides of the angle.
We can write the angle AOB as [OA [OB, AOB or AOB. We can also write [OA [OB = AOB.
The common endpoint O is called the vertex of the angle. If O is the vertex of one unique angle,
we sometimes write O to or O the mean the angle with vertex O.
sid
O
(vertex)
OA
side OB
2. Directed Angles
If we say that one of the two rays of an angle is the initial side of the angle and other side is
the terminal side of the angle, then the corresponding angle is called a directed angle.
There are two different directions about the vertex of an angle from its initial side to its
terminal side. If the angle is measured counterclockwise then the angle is called a positive
angle. If it is measured clockwise then the angle is called a negative angle.
120
Algebra 9
in
m
er
()
a
in
id
ls
id
ls
rm
te
(+)
initial side
EXAMPLE
initial side
Determine the initial and terminal side of each angle and state its direction.
a.
b.
c.
L
A
O
Solution
a. [OA is the initial side and [OB is the terminal side. AOB is a positive angle.
b. [OK is the initial side and [OL is the terminal side. KOL is a negative angle.
c. [OS is the initial side and [OR is the terminal side. SOR is a negative angle.
3. Directed Arcs
Definition
arc
The segment of a circle between the two sides of an angle AOB is called the arc
corresponding to AOB. We write AB to mean the arc corresponding to AOB.
Trigonometric Identities
121
In order to distinguish the two arcs formed by the line AB on the circle, we can plot two points
C and D as shown in the figure below. We denote the positive arc AB by ACB and the
negative arc AB by ADB.
The longer arc is called the major arc and the shorter arc is called the minor arc.
F
C
minor arc
A
diameter
D
The length of every
diameter in a given circle
is the same. For this
reason, when we talk
about the diameter of a
circle, we mean the
length of any diameter in
the circle.
major arc
AB is a chord
EF is a secant line
AB is a semicircle
A line which passes through a circle is called a secant line. A line segment AB which joins two
different points on a circle is called a chord. Any secant or chord separates a circle into two arcs.
A chord which passes through the center of a circle is called a diameter. A diameter divides a
circle into two equal arcs called semicircles.
Check Yourself 1
1. 6x2 + (a + 2)y2 = 2b + a is the equation of a unit circle. Find the values of a and b.
2. Determine
a. P 2 ,
2
3. Determine
a.
1
b. R(0, 1)
c. S(3, 3)
d. T 3 , 1
2
2
2
the initial and terminal side of each angle and indicate its direction.
b.
c.
D
Answers
1. a = 4, b = 1 2. a. yes b. yes c. no d. yes
3. a. [BA is the initial side and [BC is the terminal side. Angle ABC is a positive angle.
b. [ED is the initial side and [EF is the terminal side. Angle DEF is a positive angle.
c. [YX is the initial side and [YZ is the terminal side. Angle XYZ is a negative angle.
122
Algebra 9
complete angle
The central angle which corresponds to one complete revolution around a circle is called a
complete angle.
1. Grad
Definition
grad
When the circumference of a circle is divided into 400 equal parts, the central angle
corresponding to one of these arcs is called 1 grad and is denoted by 1G. Thus the complete
angle of a circle measures 400 1G = 400G.
400G
O
B
A
1G
The grad unit was introduced in France, where it was called the grade, in the early years of the
metric system.
2. Degree
Definition
degree
When the circumference of a circle is divided into 360 equal parts, the central angle
corresponding to one of these arcs is called 1 degree and is denoted by 1. Thus the measure
of a complete angle is 360 1 = 360.
360
O
A
1
2pr
circumference C = 2pr and arc length AB =
360
In order to measure smaller angles we use smaller angle units. Each degree can be divided
into sixty equal parts called minutes, and each minute can be divided into sixty equal parts
called seconds. 1 minute is denoted by 1 and 1 second is denoted by 1.
Trigonometric Identities
123
B
B
D 1 minute
(1)
C
A
O
m(AB) = 1
A
1 of 1 is 1
60
m(CD) = 1
1 second
(1)
F
E
C
1 of 1 is1
60
m(EF) = 1
1
in decimal degree form. We multiply the minutes by
and the seconds by
60
1
1
1
: 37 +(45 )+(30
) = 37.7583
3600
60
3600
EXAMPLE
Solution
a. 56 20 15 = 56 + 20 + 1 5
= 56.337 5
60
360 0
b. 17.86 = 17 + 0.86
= 17 + 0.86 (60)
= 17 + (51.60)
= 17 + 51 + 0.60
= 17 + 51 + 0.60 (60)
= 17 + 51 + 36
= 17 51 36
EXAMPLE
124
b. x y
Algebra 9
Solution
a. We begin by adding the degrees, minutes and seconds separately, starting with the
seconds. We can see that the sum of the seconds is 36 + 58 = 94, which is greater than 60.
Since 60 = 1 we can write 94 = 60 + 34 = 1 + 34 = 1 34. We add the extra 1
minute to the minutes part, so after adding the seconds the sum is 316 73 34.
202 15 36
202 15 36
+ 114 57 58
316 72 94
114 57 58
316 73 34
202 15 36
+ 114 57 58
316 73 34
114 57 58
317 13 34
b. We subtract the degrees, minutes and seconds separately, starting with the seconds.
However, we cannot subtract 58 from 36 directly. Instead, we carry 1 minute from the
minutes part. 15 becomes 14and the carried 1 = 60is added to 36: 60 + 36 = 96.
We can now subtract the seconds to get 96 58 = 38.
202 15 36
202 14 96
114 57 58
114 57 58
38
Similarly, we cannot subtract 57 from 14 directly. We carry 1 degree from the degrees
part so 202 becomes 201 and the carried 1 = 60 is added to 14:
60 + 14 = 74. We can now subtract the minutes to get 74 57 = 17.
202 14 96
201 74 96
114 57 58
114 57 58
38
1738
Finally we subtract the degrees: 201 114 = 87.
The final result is 87 17 38, which is the difference of the angles.
201 74 96
114 57 58
87 17 38
Trigonometric Identities
125
3. Radian
Definition
radian
Let AB be an arc of a circle with radius r such that the arc length of AB is also r. Then the
measure of the central angle corresponding to AB is called 1 radian. It is denoted by 1 rad or 1R.
2pR
r
O
1R
r
A
arc length of AB = r units
We know that the circumference C of a circle can be calculated using the formula C = 2r.
So C consists of 2 times an arc with length r. Therefore the measure of the central angle
corresponding to the complete arc of a circle is 2 radians.
The radian measure gives us an easy correspondence
B
q
r
A
arc length AB = l = q r
Remark 1
1
O
126
aR
1
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
rA=12 cm
circle A
Solution
through
4 R
.
3
circle B
O
rB=18 cm
circle B
24
4 R
, i.e. =
. So the big circle rotates
18
3
Check Yourself 2
Remember!
Complementary angles
add up to 90.
Supplementary angles
add up to 180.
127
This formula gives us the following relations between common angle measures:
180 = pR
0 = 0R
90 =
270 =
pR
2
3 pR
2
45 =
EXAMPLE
Solution
pR
4
30 =
pR
6
5 R
5
D
we have
12R , so D = 75.
b. For R
12
180
1 @ 0.0174R
128
180
0.0174 R and 1R
57.325 .
180
1R @ 57.324
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
Solution
The circumference of the Earth at the equator is 40 000 km. Find the length of the equator
corresponding to a central angle of 1 of the Earth.
The complete central angle which corresponds to the total length of the equator is 360.
40 000
Since 360 corresponds to the length 40 000 km, 1 corresponds to
111 km.
360
q = 1
Note
The rad unit or exponential
radians. If no unit is specified for an angle measure, this means that the measure is in
radians. For example, the statement means that the angle measures radians, not
2
2
degrees. From now on in this module, if we do not give a unit for an angle measure then
2
the measure is in radians.
Check Yourself 3
1. Convert the measures to radians.
a. 30
b. 135
c. 210
2. Convert the measures to degrees.
5
a.
b.
c. 5
6
3
4
Answers
3
7
1. a.
b.
c.
6
4
6
2. a. 60
b. 150
c. 225
d. 900
d. 10
d. 5
d. 1800
Trigonometric Identities
129
coterminal angles
Definition
Two or more angles whose terminal sides coincide with each other when they are in standard
position are called coterminal angles.
Let us look at an example of coterminal angles. The figure shows a unit circle.
The positive angle AOP corresponds to the arc
AEP and the negative angle AOP corresponds to
the arc AFP. These angles are coterminal. The
measure of the positive angle AOP is m(AOP) =
and the measure of the negative angle AOP is
m(AOP) = (360 ).
y
P
F
E
q
a
O
Now assume that point P in the figure is moving around the circumference of the unit circle
from point A in the counterclockwise direction. Study the following table.
Position of point P (moving counterclockwise)
Degrees
Radians
90
180
270
3
2
360
360 +
2+
720 +
4+
k 360 +
2k+
EXAMPLE
Solution
For each angle, write the set of coterminal angles with the same unit of measurement.
5
a. 175
b.
4
Coterminal angles differ by an integral multiple of complete angles.
a. {175 + k 360, k } = {...,545, 185, 175, 535, 895,...}
5
11
3 5 13 21
b. { + k 2, k } = {...,
, ,
,
,
,...}
4
4
4
4
4
4
130
Algebra 9
Note
a.
Solution
Solution
5p
175
185
3p
4
Find the arc length which corresponds to the central angle 40 on the unit circle ( 3).
40 R
2
D
R
we have
=
= , so R =
. We know that on the unit circle, the radian
180
180
9
measure of a directed angle is equal to the length of the directed arc corresponding to the
Since
b.
2
2 2 3 2
, and using 3 gives us
0.6.
9
9
9
3
Find the coordinates of the terminal point of the arc with length
which is in standard
2
position on the unit circle.
So
represents a quarter of the circle.
2
y
B(0, 1)
A(1, 0)
A(1, 0)
B(0, 1)
Trigonometric Identities
In other words, the primary directed angle of is the smallest positive angle that is
coterminal with . If we divide by 360, the remainder will be the primary directed angle.
m( ) = k (360) + m(), k .
For example, 30 is the primary directed angle of 390 because 390 = 1 360 + 30.
We know that the radian measure of any angle is equal to the length of the arc which
corresponds to its central angle in the unit circle. The circumference of a unit circle is 2.
Therefore any two real numbers that differ by integral multiples of 2 will coincide at the
same point on the circle.
131
Definition
The positive real number t which differs from a real number by integral multiples
of 2 is called a primary directed arc.
Since t is the smallest positive real number that is coterminal with a given angle , we can
find t by subtracting integral multiples of complete rotations from , or alternatively by
dividing by 2 and considering the remainder:
k (2) + t, k .
EXAMPLE
10
Solution
Find the primary directed angle of each angle, using the same unit.
75
75
a. 7320
b. 7320
c.
d.
8
8
a.
7320
7200
120
360
20
number of
rotations
x
120
x
21st rotation
20 complete rotations in the positive direction
Algebra 9
b. Solution 1
7320 = (20 360) + 120
7320 = (20 360 + 120)
= (20 360) 120
= 120
120 240
(coterminal angles)
7320 240
(coterminal angles)
Solution 2
7320 = (21) 360 + 240
Therefore the primary directed angle of 7320 is 240.
y
+240
x
x
120
21st rotation
c. Solution 1
75 64 11
=
+
8
8
8
75
11
= 4 (2 )+
8
8
number of rotations
11
Solution 2
1. Divide the numerator by twice the
denominator:
2 8 = 16 and 75 16 = (4 16) + 11.
2. Multiply the remainder by
11
: 11 =
.
denominator
8
8
Trigonometric Identities
75p
8
5th rotation
133
75 16
11
75
is
.
8
8
64 4
11
number of rotations
remainder
d. If the angle was positive, the remainder
11
would be
as we found in part c. But the
8
11
angle is negative, so the remainder is
.
8
75p
8
11
11 5
= .
2
8
8
8
5
So the primary directed angle is
.
8
we calculate
EXAMPLE
11
Solution
1 = 60 and 1 = 60 so
360 = 359 59 60.
359 59 60
30 42 15
329 17 45.
So 329 17 45.
Check Yourself 4
1. Find the primary directed angle of each angle, using the same unit of measurement.
3
33
a. 100
b. 7200
c.
d.
2
5
11
5
e. 400
f. 50
g.
h.
3
4
2. For each angle, write the set of coterminal angles with the same unit of measurement.
3
a. 30
b. 120
c.
d.
3
2
Answers
3
3
3
1. a. 100 b. 0 c.
d.
e. 320 f. 310 g.
h.
2
3
5
4
2. a. {..., 690, 330, 30, 390, ...}
b. {..., 600, 240, 120, 480, 840, ...}
11
5 7 13
5
3 7 11
,
, ,
,
, ...}
,
,
, ...}
c. {...,
d. {..., , ,
3
3 3 3
3
2
2 2
2
2
134
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
2 .1
4. Determine the direction (positive or negative) of
each angle.
a.
b.
c.
a. (a + 1)x2 + (b 2)y2 = 1
b. (2a + 5)x2 + (1 4b)y2 = 9
c. x2 + y2 + ax + (b 1)y 1 = 0
d. 2x2 + 2y2 + ax + by = 2
a.
b.
1
a. A , y
b. B
, y
2
2
N
O
2
d. D x,
c. C x, 1
3
c.
d.
R
a.
b.
C
D
F
c.
a.
d.
N
K
L
A
b.
O
O
M
Trigonometric Identities
135
c.
c.
9
revolutions clockwise
4
d.
10
revolutions counterclockwise
3
b. 80 15
c. 37 21 30
d. 89 59 60
b. 82.15
c. 54.30
d. 23.73
60
210
Radians
3
4
11
6
b. 250
c. 1200
e.
12
d. 3000
17
f.
18
g.
201
4
h. 17
6
b. 4321
90
d.
19
b. 5 .
4
A. TRIGONOMETRIC RATIOS
1. Definition
C
hypotenuse
(hyp)
opposite
side
(opp)
q
adjacent side
(adj)
Consider the right triangle in the figure. The table shows the trigonometric ratios for the
acute angle .
EXAMPLE
12
Ratio
name
Ratio
abbreviation
Ratio
definition
Abbreviated
definition
sine
sin
opp
hyp
cosine
cos
adj
hyp
tangent
tan
opp
adj
cotangent
cot
adj
opp
secant
sec
length of hypotenuse
length of side adjacent to
hyp
adj
cosecant
csc
length of hypotenuse
length of side opposite
hyp
opp
10
q
A
Trigonometric Identities
137
Solution
sin =
opp 4
=
hyp 5
cos =
adj 3
=
hyp 5
tan =
opp 4
=
adj 3
cot =
adj 3
=
opp 4
sec =
hyp 5
=
adj 3
csc =
hyp 5
=
opp 4
We know that any ratio can be expanded or simplified by multiplying its numerator and
denominator by the same non-zero number. For example:
2 2k 4 40 200
=
= =
=
=... etc. where k is any non-zero number.
3 3k 6 60 300
This property is also used in trigonometry. Look at the two right triangles below.
C
q
B
sin
a
b
sin
a
b
Although the lengths of the sides of the triangles are different, the two trigonometric ratios
a a
for the common angle are the same: = . In other words, the sides are in proportion. We
b b
say that these triangles are similar.
EXAMPLE
13
Two right triangles are shown below. Find the trigonometric ratios for the angle in each
triangle and show that they are equal.
C
C
13
a
A
12
26
10
a
A
138
24
Algebra 9
Solution sin
opp
5
hyp 13
sin
opp 10 5
hyp 26 13
cos
adj 12
hyp 13
cos
adj 24 12
hyp 26 13
tan
opp 5
adj 12
tan
opp 10
5
adj 24 12
cot
adj 12
opp 5
cot
adj 24 12
opp 10
5
The ratios are the same because the sides are in proportion: these are similar triangles.
EXAMPLE
14
2
In a right triangle, is an acute angle such that cos = . Find the sine, tangent and
3
cotangent ratios of the same angle.
hyp = 3
opp
q
2
cos q =
3
opp + 4 = 9
adj = 2
opp2 = 5 so opp = 5.
opp
5
opp
5
adj
2
=
; tan =
=
; cot =
=
.
hyp
3
adj
2
opp
5
Check Yourself 5
1. In a right triangle, is an acute angle such that tan = 4. Find the sine, cosine and
cotangent ratios of the same angle.
2. One leg of an isosceles right triangle is 1 unit long. Find all the trigonometric ratios of one
of the two equal acute angles in the triangle.
Answers
4
1
1
1. sin
, cos
, cot
4
17
17
2. sin 45 = cos 45 =
Trigonometric Identities
1
2
1
45
1
45
1
60
30 30
30
3
60
60
60
60
60
In each example we can find the unknown length using the Pythagorean Theorem:
12 + 12 = 2 and
EXAMPLE
15
B
in
degrees
in radians
sin
cos
tan
cot
30
1
2
3
2
1
3
45
1
2
1
2
60
3
2
1
2
1
3
angle of elevation
A
h
B
angle of depression
140
30
36 m
Algebra 9
Solution
1
3
EXAMPLE
16
opp
h
= .
adj 36
h
1
36
=
, and so h =
20.78 m.
36
3
3
In the figure,
m(BAD) = m(DAC) = 30
and BD = 12 units.
Find the value of x.
30
30
12
C
x
Solution
1
3
12
so AB = 123.
AB
12+ x
12 3
so 12 + x = 123 3 = 36.
So x = 36 12 = 24 units.
EXAMPLE
17
In the figure,
m(ABC) = 30,
m(ACB) = 45
and AB = 6 units.
Find the value of x.
A
6
45
30
B
Solution
1 AH
=
so AH = 3.
2
6
3 BH
=
so BH = 33. Since angle H is a right angle
2
6
and angle C measures 45 then in the triangle AHC, m(A) is also 45. Therefore AHC is an
141
Check Yourself 6
1. Find the length x in each triangle.
a.
b.
c.
15
30
30
22
60
45
B
H
C
1444442444443
x
2. Solve for x:
30
14243 D
x
tan 30 csc60
= x cot 30 sin 45.
cos 45 sin60
Answers
1. a. 4( 2 + 6 )
3
b. 23 2
c. 16
2.
8
9
B. TRIGONOMETRIC IDENTITIES
The trigonometric ratios are related to each other by equations called trigonometric identities.
1. Basic Identities
a. Pythagorean identities
Property
Pythagorean identities
For all ,
1. sin2 cos2 = 1
2. tan2 1 = sec2
3. cot2 1 = csc2 .
C
hypotenuse
(hyp)
q
A
Proof
Therefore,
Be careful!
sin2 = sin sin and
cos2 = cos cos ,
etc. We do not write
sin 2 because it is not
clear what we mean:
sin ( 2) or (sin )2?
142
opposite
side
(opp)
opp + adj
hyp
=
hyp2
hyp 2
adjacent side
(adj)
(1)
hyp 2
opp2
adj 2
+
hyp2 hyp 2
hyp 2
opp 2
adj 2
) +(
) =1.
hyp
hyp
adj
opp
, we have sin2 cos2 = 1.
Since sin
and cos
hyp
hyp
(
Algebra 9
2
hyp 2
opp 2 adj
=(
).
) +
2
adj
adj
adj
Since tan
opp
hyp
and sec
we have tan2 + 1 = sec2.
adj
adj
opp2 adj 2
hyp 2
+
=
,
opp2 opp 2
opp 2
opp2
opp
+(
adj 2
hyp 2
) =(
).
opp
opp
Since cot
hyp
adj
and csc
we have 1 + cot2 csc2 , i.e. cot2 + 1 = csc2
opp
opp
1. tan =
Proof
opp
hyp
opp
opp
sin
adj
1. We know that sin
and cos
, so
=
.
=
adj
hyp
hyp
adj
cos
hyp
sin
tan
So
cos
adj
hyp
cos
adj
cos
=
=
, i.e.
2. Similarly,
cot .
opp
sin
opp
sin
hyp
3. Consequently,
Trigonometric Identities
sin cos
1. So tan cot = 1.
cos sin
143
c. Reciprocal identities
reciprocal identities
Property
Proof
Remember!
1
sin
2. sec =
1
cos
Since csc =
1
csc =
sin
1
cos
(the first letters of
reciprocal ratios are
opposite:
1
1
c= ,s= )
c
s
sec =
EXAMPLE
1. csc =
18
Solution
1
hyp
, csc =
.
opp
sin
2. Similarly, cos =
Since sec =
opp
1
1
hyp
, so
=
=
.
opp opp
hyp
sin
hyp
adj
1
1
hyp
so
=
=
.
adj
hyp
cos
adj
hyp
hyp
1
, sec =
.
adj
cos
Verify the eight trigonometric identities using the right triangle in the figure.
First we need to calculate the length of the hypotenuse.
By the Pythagorean Theorem,
hyp2
hyp2
hyp2
hyp
=
=
=
=
22 + 32
4+9
13
13.
opp = 3
hyp
q
adj = 2
Before verifying the identities, let us write the six trigonometric ratios for the given right triangle:
sin =
3
13
, cos =
2
13
3
2
13
13
, tan = , cot = , csc =
.
, sec =
3
2
3
2
3 2
=1
2 3
1
1
13
=
=
= csc
3
sin
3
13
1
1
13
=
=
= sec
2
cos
2
13
144
Algebra 9
3
13
and sec =
, so by substitution,
2
2
3
13 2
( )2 +1=(
)
2
2
9
13
+1=
4
4
13 13
= . Therefore, tan 2 + 1 = sec 2
4
4
13
2
, so by substitution,
and csc =
3
3
2
13 2
( )2 +1=(
)
3
3
4
13
+1=
9
9
13 13
= . Therefore, cot2 + 1 = csc2 ,
9
9
sin
=
cos
13
3
cos
= = tan ,
=
2
2
sin
13
2
= = cot
3
3
13
13
sin 2 + cos 2 = (
3
13
) 2 +(
2
13
)2 =
9
4 13
+ =
=1.
13 13 13
Check Yourself 7
2
1. Verify the eight trigonometric identities for the acute angle in a right triangle if sin .
5
2. Verify the eight trigonometric identities for a right triangle with sides of length 7, 24 and
25 units.
4
3. Let be an acute angle in a right triangle such that sin .
5
Evaluate cos (tan + cot ).
21
cos 2 + sin 2
+1
5
5
4. Evaluate
.
2 tan cot
7
7
Answers
5
3.
4. 2
4
Trigonometric Identities
145
EXAMPLE
19
Solution
sin x
:
cos x
sin x
cos x
= cos x
sin x
cos x
(substitute)
(cancel)
= sin x.
So cos x tan x = sin x.
EXAMPLE
20
1
sin x
. Hence,
and csc x =
sin x
cos x
sin x
1
cos x
cos x
sin x
(substitute)
sin x
1
cos x
=1.
sin x
cos x
(cancel)
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
21
Solution
Simplify
sec x cos x
.
tan x
We know tan x =
sin x
1
and sec x =
. Hence,
cos x
cos x
1
cos x
sec x cos x cos x
=
sin x
tan x
cos x
1
cos 2 x
= cos x cos x
sin x
cos x
1 cos 2 x
= cos x
sin x
cos x
1 cos 2 x
cos x
=
sin x
cos x
sin 2 x
sin x
= sin x.
As a result,
EXAMPLE
22
Solution
Trigonometric Identities
(by substitution)
sec x cos x
= sin x.
tan x
2
x
Simplify 2+ tan
1
2
sec x
We know tan x =
sin x
1
and sec x =
. Hence,
cos x
cos x
147
2+ tan 2 x
1=
sec 2 x
sin x 2
)
cos x 1
1 2
(
)
cos x
2+(
(by substitution)
sin 2 x
cos 2 x 1
1
cos 2 x
2+
2 cos 2 x sin 2 x
+
2
cos 2 x 1
= cos x
1
cos 2 x
2 cos 2 x + sin 2 x
cos 2 x
=
1
1
cos 2 x
2 cos 2 x + sin 2 x
=
cos 2 x
1
cos 2 x
= cos2 x + 1 1
= cos2 x + 1 1
(by cancellation)
= cos2 x.
2
x
As a result, 2+ tan
1 = cos 2 x.
2
sec x
Check Yourself 8
Simplify the expressions.
1. cos x tan x
2.
1+ csc x
cos x + cot x
3.
1
1
+
1 sin x 1+ sin x
Answers
1. sin x
148
2. sec x
3. 2 sec2 x
Algebra 9
23
Solution
= sin x
cos x
sin x
cos x
= cos x.
sin x
(by substitution)
(simplify)
sin x
cot x = sin x cot x.
cos x
(by substitution)
(tan x cot x = 1)
(by substitution)
(simplify)
24
Solution
Trigonometric Identities
sin x
cos x
and cot x =
, so
cos x
sin x
149
sin x cos x
+
)
cos x sin x
(by substitution)
sin 2 x + cos 2 x
)
cos x sin x
= cos x
sin
cos
x
x
(cancel)
1
= csc x.
sin x
We have obtained the other side of the identity and the verification is complete.
EXAMPLE
25
Solution
2
Verify the identity (sin x + cos x) = 2+ sec x csc x.
sin x cos x
(cos2 x + sin2 x = 1)
2 sin x cos x
1
+
sin x cos x
sin x cos x
= 2+ csc x sec x
(simplify)
We have obtained the right-hand side of the identity and the verification is complete.
EXAMPLE
26
Solution
tan x
= sec x cos x.
csc x
150
sin x sin x
cos x 1
(by substitution)
Algebra 9
sin 2 x
cos x
1 cos 2 x
cos x
(cos2 x + sin2 x = 1)
1
cos 2 x
cos x cos x
(multiply)
= sec x cos x
We have obtained the right-hand side of the identity and so the verification is complete.
EXAMPLE
27
Solution
cos x
1 sin x
.
1 sin x
cos x
=
1 sin x 1 sin x 1+ sin x
(multiply by 1)
1+ sin x
(cancel the common factor)
cos x
This is the right-hand side of the identity, so the verification is complete.
Check Yourself 9
Verify the identities.
1. sec x cos x = sin x tan x
Trigonometric Identities
2.
cos x
= csc x sin x
sec x sin x
3.
1+ sin x
cos x
+
= 2 sec x
cos x
1+ sin x
151
4. Cofunctions
We have studied the trigonometric functions of certain angles and the trigonmetric ratios
between the sides and angles of a right triangle. In this section we will look at the relation
between the trigonometric ratios of complementary angles.
R
. Consider the right
2
triangle ABC with acute angles and shown in the figure. and are complementary angles.
b
C
We can also write sin = cos = . In other
a
words, the sine of and the cosine of its
a
Recall that complementary angles are angles whose sum is 90, i.e.
3
sin = cos( ) = cos
and
5
2 5
10
cos
EXAMPLE
28
152
3
3
= sin(
) = sin , etc.
8
2 8
8
5
+[tan
tan ]+ sin 2
7
18
9
14
Algebra 9
Solution
a. The angles in each pair (89, 1), (88, 2), ..., (46, 44) are complementary.
Because tangent and cotangent are cofunctions,
tan 89 = cot 1, tan 88 = cot 2, ... , tan 46 = cot 44.
So tan 1 tan 2 tan 3 ... tan 88 tan 89
= tan 1 tan 2 tan 3 ... tan 44 tan 45 cot 44 ... cot 2 cot 1
= 1 1 1 ... tan 45 ... 1 1 = 1.
5
5
since +
= .
b. The complement of is
7
14
7 14 2
Similarly, the complement of
7
7
is
since
+ = .
18
9
18 9 2
So sin
So sin 2
+ tan
tan + sin 2
= sin 2 +[cot tan ]+cos 2
7
18
9
14
7
9
9
7
=1+1
= 2.
Check Yourself 10
1. Write the cofunction of each function.
a. tan 15
d. sin
b. cos 36
12
e. cot
c. sec 77
2
5
f. tan
2
7
5
b. tan tan
cos 2 27 cos 2 63
7
14
Answers
1. a. cot 75
2. a. 1 b. 0
Trigonometric Identities
b. sin 54
c. csc 13
d. cos
5
12
e. tan
10
f. cot
3
14
153
Eratosthenes was a famous mathematician and the head of the famous library in
Alexandria, Egypt. In 240 BC he calculated the Earth's circumference using
trigonometry and his knowledge of the angle of elevation of the Sun at the summer
solstice in the Egyptian cities of Alexandria and Syene (now called Aswan).
Eratosthenes calculation was based on the assumptions that the Earth is a sphere
and that the sun is so far away that we can consider its rays to be parallel.
Eratosthenes
compared
observations
made
in
Alexandria,
where
the
noontime Sun at the summer solstice was 7 away from straight overhead (the
zenith), to observations in Syene in southern Egypt, where the Sun was exactly at
its zenith. The distance between the cities was known to be about 5000 stadia,
roughly equal to 800 km (the stadion, plural stadia, was an old unit of measurement
such that 1 stadia 160 m). Therefore, Eratosthenes calculated the entire 360
circle of the Earth to be (360/7) 5000 stadia, which is about 260,000 stadia, or
41,000 km.
a2
a1
local horizon
A
a 1 a2
154
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
2 .2
A. Trigonometric Ratios
1. tan x =
5. In the figure,
m(C) = 120,
m(A) = 30
and AB = 26.
Calculate the
height h.
17
that x is in the first quadrant.
a. cot x
b. sin x
c. cos x
30
26
h
120
a.
AD = 3,
DB = 5 and
x
B
Calculate BC = x.
60
5
m(ADC) = 60.
B
60
b.
A
3
15
B
3. In the figure,
m(DAC) = 45,
m(BAC) = 30 and
BC = 32.
series of 30-60-90
32
45
Calculate DC = x.
30
right triangles,
increasing in size from
right to left. The length of
the hypotenuse of the eighth
triangle in the series is 72 units.
Calculate AO.
IV D
III
C
II
B
30
B. Trigonometric Identities
4.
30
120
3
A
b. sec2 x tan2 x
1 sin x
d.
1 csc x
f.
cot x 1
1 tan x
155
I
A
cos x
sec x + tan x
tan
a.
sin x
csc x
1 cos x
e.
1
1
+
2
sec x csc2 x
b.
2
3
tan
sin 2
7
14
10
2 2
1 cos
5
tan 25 tan65
+2
sin2 25 + sin 2 65
13. Evaluate
sin 2
5
+ sin 2
+ cos 2
+ cos 2 .
8
8
12
12
(sin x + cos x) 2
sin 2 x cos 2 x
=
2
2
sin x cos x (sin x cos x) 2
1 sin x
= (sec x tan x) 2
1+ sin x
e. csc x sin x = cos x cot x
d.
cos x
sin x cos x
=
1 sin x cos x cot x
c.
1
1
= 2 sec x tan x
1 sin x 1 sin x
d.
tan x cot x
= sin x cos x
tan 2 x cot 2 x
156
1+ cos x
2
= cot x csc x
1 cos x
Algebra 9
A. TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
Up to now we have defined the trigonometric ratios of acute angles in a right triangle.
However, we can in fact calculate trigonometric ratios for any angle. In this section we will
extend our knowledge of trigonometric ratios to cover all angles. To do this, we will study the
trigonometric functions in the context of the unit circle. From now on in this module, we will
use the terms trigonometric ratio, trigonometric value and trigonometric function value
interchangeably.
The trigonometric functions are also called circular functions since they can be defined on the
unit circle.
The figures below show how the value of sin changes as the point P moves round the unit
circle.
y
sin a
1
a
O
1
x
Trigonometric Identities
sin a
a
1
P
first quadrant:
p
0<a<
2
second quadrant:
p
<a<p
2
O
sin a
third quadrant:
3p
p<a<
2
a
O
sin a
A
x
1
P
fourth quadrant:
3p
< a < 2p
2
157
if
if
3
then 1 sin 0;
2
3
2 then 1 sin 0.
2
sin a
sin a
then 0 sin 1;
2
a increasing,
sin a positive
and increasing
p
2 B
a
p
O
sin a
if
then 0 sin 1;
2
a increasing,
sin a negative
and decreasing
0 A
2p
sin a
if 0
y
a increasing,
sin a positive
and decreasing
3p B
2
a increasing,
sin a negative
and increasing
Conclusion
1. For all values of the sine function takes values between 1 and 1, i.e. 1 sin 1.
2. As increases, the sine function increases in the first and fourth quadrants and decreases
in the second and third quadrants.
3. The sine function is positive in the first and second quadrants and negative in the third
and fourth quadrants.
EXAMPLE
29
3
+5sin
sin
2
2
b. 4sin 2 2 sin
Solution
+ 4sin + sin 0
2
2
a. 3 1 + 5 (1) 0 = 2
b. 4 0 2 (1) + 4 1 + 0 = 6
158
Algebra 9
y
P
1
A
a
cos a
O
1
x
cos a
cos a
second quadrant:
p
<a<p
2
third quadrant:
3p
p<a<
2
then 0 cos 1;
2
if
3
then 1 cos 0;
2
3
2 then 0 cos 1.
2
fourth quadrant:
3p
< a < 2p
2
y
a increasing,
cos a negative and
decreasing
a increasing,
cos a positive
and decreasing
p
2 B
a
then 1 cos 0;
if
2
if
1
P
P
first quadrant:
p
0<a<
2
cos a A
cos a
A
p
a
a increasing,
cos a negative
and increasing
cos a
cos a
cos a
A0
2p
a
3p B
2
a increasing,
cos a positive
and increasing
159
Conclusion
1. For all values of , the cosine function takes values between 1 and 1, i.e. 1 cos 1.
2. As increases, the cosine function decreases in the first and second quadrants and increases
in the third and fourth quadrants.
3. The cosine function is positive in the first and fourth quadrants and negative in the
second and third quadrants.
EXAMPLE
30
Solution
160
Algebra 9
R(x2, 1)
Q(1, y2)
P(x1, y1)
y2
y1
a
x1
A(1, 0)
A(1, 0)
B(0, 1)
x2
respectively.
B(0, 1)
Definition
x=1
y2
tangent axis
Note
y-axis. Since the y-axis is parallel to the line x = 1, the intersection point Q does not exist
and so at these points the tangent function is not defined.
Trigonometric Identities
161
The figures below show how the value of tan changes as moves round the circle.
Notice that we extend the terminal side of the angle in the second and third quadrants to
find its intersection with the tangent line x = 1.
y
x=1
tan a
x=1
tan a
B
A
a
O
a
x
x=1
Q
B
O
tan a
x=1
Q
Q
tan a
tangent axis
first quadrant:
p
0<a<
2
tangent axis
tangent axis
second quadrant:
p
<a<p
2
third quadrant:
3p
p<a<
2
tangent axis
fourth quadrant:
3p
< a < 2p
2
then 0 tan ;
2
3
if
2 then tan 0 .
2
O
tan a
3
then 0 tan ;
2
tan a
if
then tan 0 ;
2
if
x=1
B
tan a is an increasing function in every quadrant
Conclusion
1. For all values of , the tangent function takes values between and .
Algebra 9
y
cotangent axis
R(x2, 1)=R(cot a, 1)
y=1
x2
Note
The real numbers k (k ) correspond to the points A(1, 0) and A'(1, 0) on the unit
circle. At these points the terminal side of the angle coincides with the positive or negative
x-axis. Since the x-axis is parallel to the line y = 1, the intersection point R does not exist
and so at these points the cotangent function is not defined.
The figures below show how the value of cot changes as moves round the circle. Notice
that we extend the terminal side of the angle in the third and fourth quadrants to find its
intersection with the cotangent line y = 1.
y
y
R
y=1
cotangent axis
a
y
B
y=1
cotangent axis
cot a
A
cot a
3p
2
y=1
second quadrant:
Trigonometric Identities
p
2
cotangent axis
a
cot a
y=1
p
<a<p
2
B
cotangent axis
cot a
aO
163
then 0 cot ;
2
cot a
cot a
B
then cot 0 ;
2
if
if
cot a
3
then 0 cot ;
2
3
2 then cot 0 .
2
B
cot a is a decreasing function in every quadrant
Conclusion
1. For all values of , the cotangent function takes values between and .
2. The cotangent function is not defined for the values = k (k ).
3. In each quadrant, as increases the cotangent function decreases.
4. The cotangent function is positive in the first and third quadrants and negative in the
second and fourth quadrants.
EXAMPLE
31
Solution
5
2
7
, b = cot
, c = cot
9
3
9
EXAMPLE
164
32
7
2
5
5 2 7
cot
cot
. So c < b < a.
means cot
9
3
9
9
3
9
b.
c. cos 72 = sin 18
d.
a.
b.
x=1
B
tan 37
sin 37
37
O
57
B
H1
P1
72
S
72
18
y=1
R
P
cos 57
cot 57
Solution
44
P2
72
18
O
A
H2
46
D
B
S
P
1
O
d
165
Definition
Note
parallel to the x-axis. Therefore the intersection point C does not exist and so at these points
the secant function is not defined.
Definition
Note
The real numbers k (k ) correspond to the points A(1, 0) and A'(1, 0) on the unit
circle. At these points, P coincides with the points A or A' and the tangent line at P becomes
parallel to the y-axis. Therefore the intersection point D does not exist and so at these points
the cosecant function is not defined.
The figures below show how the values of sec and csc change as moves round the
circle.
d
D(0, cosec a)
P
a
O
first quadrant:
p
0<a<
2
166
D(0, cosec a)
P
1
1
C(sec a, 0)
C(sec a, 0)
O
second quadrant:
p
<a<p
2
Algebra 9
a
O
C(sec a, 0)
1
P
C(sec a, 0)
1
P
D(0, cosec a)
third quadrant:
3p
p<a<
2
D(0, cosec a)
fourth quadrant:
3p
< a < 2p
2
if 0 < < then 1 < sec < and 1 < csc < ;
2
if
< < then < sec < 1 and 1 < csc < ;
2
if < <
if
3
then < sec < 1 and < csc < 1;
2
3
< < 2 then 1 < sec < and < csc < 1.
2
Conclusion
1. For all values of , the secant and cosecant functions take
values in (1, 1).
2. The secant function is not defined for the values = + k ( k ) and the cosecant
2
function is not defined for the values = k (k ).
167
Example
33
B(0, 1)
P
Solution
B(0, 1)
OH + HA = 1, so cos + HA = 1,
?
P
i.e. HA = 1 cos .
OP OH
Since PH||QA,
=
.
PQ HA
PQ =
1 cos
1
cos
=
, i.e. PQ =
,
This gives
cos
PQ 1 cos
A(1, 0)
a
O
cos a
A(1, 0)
H 1 cos a
1
1.
cos
As a result, PQ = sec 1.
quadrantal angle
If the terminal side of an angle coincides with a
coordinate axis then the angle is called a
quarantal angle. If an angle is not quadrantal, it
is called a nonquadrantal angle.
y
B(0, 1)
p 90
2
A(1, 0) 180
p
0 A(1, 0)
O
360 2p
3p
2 270
B(0, 1)
the angles 0+ kp and p + kp (k )
2
are quadrantal angles
168
Algebra 9
We can calculate the trigonometric values of quadrantal angles by observing at the points at
which the terminal sides of the angles intersect the unit circle.
Trigonometric Values of Quadrantal Angles
EXAMPLE
34
q in degrees
q in radians
sin q (y)
cos q (x)
tan q (y/x)
cot q (x/y)
sec q (1/x)
csc q (1/y)
undefined
undefined
90
p
2
undefined
undefined
180
undefined
undefined
270
3p
2
undefined
undefined
360
2p
undefined
undefined
Solution
EXAMPLE
35
Solution
3
a. sin + cos + tan 0 cot
2
2
a. 0 + 0 + 0 0 = 0
b. sin
b. 1 0 0 1 = 2
EXAMPLE
36
Solution The angles are all greater than 360 so we begin by finding the primary directed angle of each
term.
sin 1710 = sin (4 360 + 270) = sin 270
cos 2520 = cos (7 360 + 0) = cos 0
cot 450 = cot (360 + 90) = cot 90
tan 900 = tan (2 360 + 180) = tan 180
Hence,
sin 1710 cos 2520 + cot 450 tan 900 = sin 270 cos 0 + cot 90 tan 180
= 1 1 + 0 0 = 2.
Trigonometric Identities
169
Check Yourself 11
Evaluate each expression by using the table of trigonometric values for quadrantal angles.
1. 2 sin 180 + tan + 5 cot 270 + 3 cos 180.
4 cos 0 10 sin
2
2.
2 sin 270 cos
Answers
1. 3
2. 6
reference angle
The positive acute angle which is formed by the terminal side of a nonquadrantal angle and
the x-axis is called the reference angle for .
Look at the figures. They show how to find the reference angle for an angle in each
quadrant.
y
a=q
O
q
O
170
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
37
Solution
b. 150
c. 215
d. 317
Now that we can calculate reference angles we are ready to calculate the trigonometric value
of a nonquadrantal angle. To do this, follow the steps:
1. Find the primary directed angle of the nonquadrantal angle and determine its quadrant.
2. Determine the sign of the function in this quadrant.
3. Calculate the reference angle for the given angle.
4. Find the trigonometric value of the reference angle and use it with the sign from step 2.
EXAMPLE
38
Solution
b. sin 330
c. sec 240
d. csc 120
e. sin 510
f. cos 945
g. tan (930)
h. cot (675)
y
sin a
cos a
tana
cot a
sec a
csc a
(+)
()
()
()
()
(+)
sin a
cos a
tana
cot a
sec a
csc a
sin a
cos a
tana
cot a
sec a
csc a
O
()
()
(+)
(+)
()
()
(+)
(+)
(+)
(+)
(+)
(+)
x
sin a
cos a
tana
cot a
sec a
csc a
()
(+)
()
()
(+)
()
Trigonometric Identities
171
2
3
e. 1. 510 = 360 + 150. So the primary directed angle of 510 is 150 and it is in the
second quadrant.
2. In the second quadrant, the sine function is positive.
3. = 180 150 = 30
4. sin 510 sin 1 50 sin 30
1
2
f. 1. 945 = (2 360) + 225. So the primary directed angle is 225 and it is in the third quadrant.
2. In the third quadrant, the cosine function is negative.
3. = 225 180 = 45
4. cos 945 cos 225 cos 45
1
2
g. 1. 930 = (3 360) + 150. So the primary directed angle is 150 and it is in the
second quadrant.
2. In the second quadrant, the tangent function is negative.
3. = 180 150 = 30
4. tan ( 930 ) = tan 1 50
= tan 30
=
1
3
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
39
Solution
a. 1.
7
6
b. tan
31
4
25
c. sin
47
d. cos
7
7
7
2 so
= + so the
2 . So this is a primary directed angle. Moreover,
6
6
6
6
angle is in the third quadrant.
cot
= cot = 3
6
6
31
2, we need to write the angle as a primary directed angle:
4
7
31
7
and it is in the fourth quadrant.
= (3 2 )+ . So the primary directed angle is
4
4
4
2. In the fourth quadrant, the tangent function is negative.
b. 1. Since
3.
4.
=
4
4
31
7
tan
= tan
= tan = 1
4
4
4
= 2
25
2, we need to write the angle as a primary directed angle.
3
25
5
c. 1. Since
3.
4.
5
3
25
sin
= sin =
= sin
3
3
3
2
d. 1.
47
47
= 6 (2 )+ .
2 so we need to find the primary directed angle:
4
4
4
The angle is in the first quadrant.
3. = 0 =
4
4
4.
Trigonometric Identities
1
47
cos
= cos =
4
2
4
173
Check Yourself 12
1. Find the reference angle for each angle.
a. 890
b. 5000
c. 850
d. 2500
50
32
103
11
e.
f.
g.
h.
11
7
6
5
2. Find each trigonometric value by using a reference angle.
a. sin 570
b. tan 405
19
27
f. cos
3
4
Answers
1. a. 10
b. 40
c. 50
e. cot
2. a.
1
2
b. 1
c.
3
2
c. cos (2550)
d. cot (7950)
g. sin 45
4
25
h. tan
d. 20
d. 3
3
7
3
e.
3
e.
f.
f.
2
2
g.
5
11
h.
g.
2
2
h.
3
3
40
Solution
For each trigonometric ratio in the given quadrant, find the five other trigonometric ratios
for same angle.
1
2
a. sin , (0 , 90 )
b. cos , (90 , 180 )
3
5
3
c. tan 7 , , 3
d. cot 6, , 2
4
2
2
We will use the abbreviations opp, adj and hyp to mean the opposite side, adjacent side and
hypotenuse of a triangle with respect to the angle .
a. The angle is in the first quadrant. In this quadrant, both axes are positive and so the sine
and cosine values will be positive. By the Pythagorean Theorem,
(+)
hyp2 = adj2 + 22
2
2
2
5 = adj + 2
5
adj2 = 25 4
+2
q
q
adj = 21.
(+)
+x
21
2
21
5
5
, tan =
, cot =
, sec =
, csc .
5
2
2
21
21
Algebra 9
(+)
+y
qq
1
(+)
1
adj
1
cos can be taken as cos
= .
3
hyp 3
3
3
2 2
2 2
1
3, csc
.
, tan
2 2, cot
, sec
1
2
2
3
1
2 2
opp 7 7
using the signs of
adj 4 4
the axes in the third quadrant. By the Pythagorean
c. Similarly, tan
7
65
, cos =
4
65
, cot
4
()
(+)
4 4
,
7 7
()
65
65
, csc
.
4
7
adj
6
6
using the signs of the
1
opp
axes in the fourth quadrant.
d. Finally, cot
Trigonometric Identities
1
6
, cos =
,
37
37
(+)
q
+6
1
r
()
37 csc 37 37.
1
,
, sec
1
6
6
175
Check Yourself 13
1. Find the sine, cosine and tangent ratios of each angle without using a trigonometric table
or calculator.
2
3
2. a. tan = 5, (180, 270) are given.
a. = 315
c. = 900
b.
d.
63
2
2
3
=
,
3
2
c. sin 900 = 0,
d. sin
63
= 1,
2
2. a. sin =
b. sin =
5
26
3 11
10
cos 315
cos
1
2
2
1
,
3
2
cos 900 = 1,
cos
63
= 0,
2
cos =
tan 315 = 1
tan
2
3
3
tan 900 = 0
tan
63
is undefined
2
1
26
tan = 311
Algebra 9
Trigonometric Table
angle
Trigonometric Identities
sin
cos
tan
angle
sin
cos
tan
0
1
2
3
4
5
0.0000
0.0175
0.0349
0.0523
0.0698
0.0872
1.0000
0.9998
0.9994
0.9986
0.9976
0.9962
0.0000
0.0175
0.0349
0.0524
0.0699
0.0875
45
46
47
48
49
50
0.7071
0.7193
0.7314
0.7431
0.7547
0.7660
0.7071
0.6947
0.6820
0.6691
0.6561
0.6428
1.0000
1.0355
1.0724
1.1106
1.1504
1.1918
6
7
8
9
10
0.1045
0.1219
0.1392
0.1564
0.1736
0.9945
0.9925
0.9903
0.9877
0.9848
0.1051
0.1228
0.1405
0.1584
0.1763
51
52
53
54
55
0.7771
0.7880
0.7986
0.8090
0.8192
0.6293
0.6157
0.6018
0.5878
0.5736
1.2349
1.2799
1.3270
1.3764
1.4281
11
12
13
14
15
0.1908
0.2079
0.2250
0.2419
0.2588
0.9816
0.9781
0.9744
0.9703
0.9659
0.1944
0.2126
0.2309
0.2493
0.2679
56
57
58
59
60
0.8290
0.8387
0.8480
0.8572
0.8660
0.5592
0.5446
0.5299
0.5150
0.5000
1.4826
1.5399
1.6003
1.6643
1.7321
16
17
18
19
20
0.2756
0.2924
0.3090
0.3256
0.3420
0.9613
0.9563
0.9511
0.9455
0.9397
0.2867
0.3057
0.3249
0.3443
0.3640
61
62
63
64
65
0.8746
0.8829
0.8910
0.8988
0.9063
0.4848
0.4695
0.4540
0.4384
0.4226
1.8040
1.8807
1.9626
2.0503
2.1445
21
22
23
24
25
0.3584
0.3746
0.3907
0.4067
0.4226
0.9336
0.9272
0.9205
0.9135
0.9063
0.3839
0.4040
0.4245
0.4452
0.4663
66
67
68
69
70
0.9135
0.9205
0.9272
0.9336
0.9397
0.4067
0.3907
0.3746
0.3584
0.3420
2.2460
2.3559
2.4751
2.6051
2.7475
26
27
28
29
30
0.4384
0.4540
0.4695
0.4848
0.5000
0.8988
0.8910
0.8829
0.8746
0.8660
0.4877
0.5095
0.5317
0.5543
0.5774
71
72
73
74
75
0.9455
0.9511
0.9563
0.9613
0.9659
0.3256
0.3090
0.2924
0.2756
0.2588
2.9042
3.0777
3.2709
3.4874
3.7321
31
32
33
34
35
0.5150
0.5299
0.5446
0.5592
0.5736
0.8572
0.8480
0.8387
0.8290
0.8192
0.6009
0.6249
0.6494
0.6745
0.7002
76
77
78
79
80
0.9703
0.9744
0.9781
0.9816
0.9848
0.2419
0.2250
0.2079
0.1908
0.1736
4.0108
4.3315
4.7046
5.1446
5.6713
36
37
38
39
40
0.5878
0.6018
0.6157
0.6293
0.6428
0.8090
0.7986
0.7880
0.7771
0.7660
0.7265
0.7536
0.7813
0.8098
0.8391
81
82
83
84
0.9877
0.9903
0.9925
0.9945
0.1564
0.1392
0.1219
0.1045
6.3138
7.1154
8.1443
9.5144
41
42
43
44
45
0.6561
0.6691
0.6820
0.6947
0.7071
0.7547
0.7431
0.7314
0.7193
0.7071
0.8693
0.9004
0.9325
0.9657
1.0000
85
86
87
88
89
90
0.9962
0.9976
0.9986
0.9994
0.9998
1.0000
0.0872
0.0698
0.0523
0.0349
0.0175
0.0000
11.4301
14.3007
19.0811
28.6363
57.2900
undefined
177
EXAMPLE
41
Solution
EXAMPLE
42
Solution
0.0050
25
x
25 0.0050
x=
0.0021.
60
We add this value to the sine of 73 to get sin 73.25 0.9563 + 0.0021 = 0.9584.
Of course, the sine function does not actually increase linearly in this way. However, its
change over one degree is approximately linear, and the question only asks for an
approximate value.
EXAMPLE
43
Solution
cot = 1.13 is given. Use a trigonometric table to find the approximate value of the angle
in degree-minute form.
We cannot find the cotangent value 1.13 directly in the table.
The value is between the values cot 41 = tan 49 = 1.1504 and cot 42 = tan 48 = 1.1106.
1. The cotangent
function is decreasing
in every quadrant, so
cot 41 > cot 42.
2. cot 41 = tan 49
cot 42 = tan 48
178
Algebra 9
For 1 = 60 the cotangent value decreases by 1.1504 1.1106 = 0.0398. The decrease in
value between 41 and is 1.1504 1.13 = 0.0204.
To get the approximate value, we assume that the cotangent function is linear in the interval
[41, 42].
60
0.0398
x
0.0204
0.0204 60
31
x
0.0398
We add this value to the cotangent of 41 to get cot 4131 1.13. As a result, 4131.
b. Using a calculator
The easiest way to find a trigonometric ratio today is with the help of a secientific calculator.
Note
The steps shown in these examples may be slightly different on different models of calculator.
The examples show results rounded to four decimal places, although your calculator will
round to more than this.
EXAMPLE
44
Solution
EXAMPLE
45
Solution
Display
Enter 53
53
0.6018...
Trigonometric Identities
Keys pressed
Keys pressed
Display
Enter 28.25
28.25
0.4733...
179
EXAMPLE
46
Solution
Keys pressed
Step
Display
Enter 10.07
10.07
Find
84.3288...
The abbreviation inv or arc means the inverse of the trigonometric function. We want to find
the value of such that tan = 10.07, so we need to use the inverse tangent function.
Check Yourself 14
1. Find each trigonometric value rounded to four significant figures.
a. sin 36
b. cos 44.16
2. Find the angle for each trigonometric value, rounded to the nearest degree.
Significant figures are
the minimum number of
digits needed to write a
given value in scientific
notation without loss of
accuracy.
a. tan = 0.3057
b. sec = 1.5243
3. Find the angle for each trigonometric value, in degrees rounded to two significant figures.
a. csc = 5
b. cot = 1.2345
Answers
1. a. 0.5878
b. 0.7174
2. a. 17
b. 49
3. a. 11
b. 39
180
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
2 .3
B. Calculating Trigonometric Values
A. Trigonometric Functions
1. Complete the table of trigonometric functions on
cos
q in
q in
sin q
Degree Radian (y)
0
x/y
1
0
cot q
(x/y)
2p
undefined
1
0
270
1/x
tan q
(y/x)
sec q
(1/x)
csc q
(1/y)
1
p
2
180
tan
cos q
(x)
undefined
undefined
undefined
undefined
undefined
undefined
csc
2
3 5
b. B ,
7
7
1 1
b. D ,
2 2
b. 112
c. 212
d. 312
e. 50
f. 150
g. 250
h. 350
b. 140
c. 245
d. 305
e. 5
f. 95
g. 260
h. 320
181
b. 3456
f. 6789
c. 3000
g. 1000
d. 7890
h. 2345
Quadrant,
axis
sin
y
x
y
r
x
r
cos tan cot sec csc
y
y
r
r
x
x
x>0
y>0
II
x<0
y>0
III
x<0
y<0
IV
x>0
y<0
+
+
+
11
b.
7
12
c.
18
13
d.
25
14
e.
2
13
f.
9
15
g.
22
17
h.
36
19
b.
7
10
c.
13
12
d.
23
14
e.
f.
8
9
g.
17
12
h.
28
15
a.
c.
e.
g.
sin 120
tan 315
sin 855
tan 2025
b. cos 240
d. cot 135
f. cos 3660
h. cot 1410
a.
73
6
b.
e.
57
7
f. 1007
73
182
c.
101
13
g. 602
98
d.
angle.
1001
15
h. 1009
99
a.
c.
e.
g.
sin (225)
tan (300)
sin (1590)
tan (9045)
b. cos (150)
d. cot (30)
f. cos (675)
h. cot (600)
Algebra 9
5
a. sin
6
c. tan
5
4
b. cos
3
d. cot
11
6
e. sin
4
2
f. cos
3
g. tan 5
4
7
h. cot
6
)+cot ( + )
2
2
67
6
55
c. tan
4
a. sin
100
3
607
d. cot
6
b. cos
83
e. sin
202
f. cos
g. tan 151
4
89
h. cot
b. cos =
2
, (90 , 180 )
2
5
c. tan = , (180 , 270 )
4
2
d. cot = , (270 , 360 )
3
a. sin =
, , 2
2
2
b. cos =
24
3
, ,
25
2
c. tan = 4, ,
2
d. cot = 7, 0,
2
183
a. If
3 sin +1 2
= , what is sin ?
4 5 sin 5
b. If
cos 2
1
= , what is cos ?
7 cos +11
6
a. 48.5
b. 136.2
c. 213.75
d. 313.79
tan +5
tan 4
=
, what is tan ?
6
2
d. (tan 45 cot ) + (sec 60 cot ) = 12 is
c. If
a. 121 15
b. 346 50
c. 198 19
d. 23 56 12
sin 10
2
22+ csc
= 4
3+ 4csc
m(ABC) = 150,
AB = 6 and
BC = 3.
Calculate
a. AC = x.
a. sin 23.4
b. cos 54.25
c. tan 71.1
d. cot 63.55
150
B
decimal places.
a. sin 121 15
120
trapezoid ABCD in
the figure.
b. cos 346 50
c. tan 131 27
A
184
10
d. cot 89 49
Algebra 9
A. TRIGONOMETRIC FORMULAS
1. Sum and Difference Formulas
In this section we will learn the relations between the sum or difference of two angles and
their trigonometric ratios. We will prove these relations using the trigonometric identities we
have studied.
a. sin(xy)
In the figure,
A(ABC) = A(ABH) + A(ACH). By the
formula for the area of a triangle,
1
1
1
b c sin A = c h sin x + b h sin y,
2
2
2
which we can rewrite as
(b c sin A) = (c h sin x) + (b h sin y).
If we divide both sides by b c we get
h
h
sin A = sin x + sin y.
b
c
y
b
c
h
(1)
h
h
and cos x = .
c
b
EXAMPLE
47
Solution
Trigonometric Identities
EXAMPLE
48
Solution
2 3
2 1
+
2 2
2 2
6+ 2
6+ 2
. So sin75 =
.
4
4
3 2
1 2
)(
)
2 2
2 2
6 2
4
b. cos(xy)
y
b
C
H
155555555525555555553
= sin ((90 x) y)
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
49
Solution
EXAMPLE
50
Solution 1
1 2
3 2
2 2
2 2
2 6
4
Solution 2
1 3
3 1
0.
2 2
2 2
1
3
c. tan(xy)
We know that tan =
sin
sin ( x + y) (sin x cos y)+(cos x sin y)
. So tan ( x+ y) =
=
by
cos
cos ( x+ y) (cos x cos y) (sin x sin y)
187
1
cos x cos y
tan ( x+ y) =
tan x+ tan y
1 (tan x tan y)
EXAMPLE
51
Solution
tan x tan y
1+ (tan x tan y )
tan x + tan ( y)
.
1 (tan x tan ( y))
3
.
3
210 = 180 + 30
tan 210 = tan (180 + 30 )=
3
3 = 3
=
3
3
1 0
3
0+
EXAMPLE
52
Solution
5 1
tan x tan y
tan ( x y) =
= 2 4 =
1+(tan x tan y) 1+ 5 1
2 4
=
188
1
5
and tan y = .
4
2
9
4
13
8
18
13
Algebra 9
d. cot(xy)
cot ( x + y) =
1
cos ( x + y) (cos x cos y) (sin x sin y)
=
=
tan( x + y) sin ( x + y) (sin x cos y)+(cos x sin y)
Let us divide the numerator and denominator by sin x sin y and simplify:
(cos x cos y) (sin x sin y)
sin x sin y
cot ( x y) =
(sin x cos y)+(cos x sin y)
sin x sin y
cos x cos y sin x sin y
1
sin x sin y
. So
=
cos y cos x
+
sin y sin x
cot ( x+ y) =
(cot x cot y) 1
cot y+ cot x
cot ( x y) =
Note
.
cot x cot ( y) 1
.
cot ( y)+ cot x
(cot x cot y) 1
, i.e.
cot y + cot x
(cot x cot y) +1
cot y cot x
We can also calculate these results by using the corresponding results for the tangent and the
1
1
).
fact that cot =
(so cot ( x y) =
tan ( x y)
tan
EXAMPLE
53
Solution
Trigonometric Identities
3 2 3+1 4 2 3
=
=2 3
2
2
189
Check Yourself 15
1. Calculate cos 15 and sin 105.
2. Calculate tan 195 and cot 285.
3. Verify the results.
1
2
b. cos 300 =
2
2
4. Calculate tan 15 + cot 15.
4
5. cot x = 1 and cot y = are given. Find cot (x y).
3
Answers
2+ 6
1. cos 15 = sin 105 =
2. tan 195 = 2 3, cot 285 = 3 2
4
a. sin 135 =
4. 4
5. 7
a. sin 2x
We know that sin (x + y) = (sin x cos y) + (cos x sin y).
If x = y this formula becomes
sin (x + x) = (sin x cos x) + (cos x sin x), i.e.
sin 2x = 2sin x cos x
We can also rewrite this as sin x cos x =
EXAMPLE
54
Solution
sin 2 x
.
2
190
(double-angle formula)
3 1
2 2
3
2
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
55
Solution
b. 6 sin
cos
8
8
sin 2 x
gives us
2
1
sin (2 22.5) cos 45
2
1
= sin 45 cos 45
2
b. 6sin
56
Solution
1 1
sin (2 45)
2 2
1
1
sin 90 = .
4
4
EXAMPLE
Simplify
3 2
2
cos 6 x sin 6 x
.
cos 2 x sin 2 x
cos 6 x sin 6 x (cos 6 x sin 2 x) (cos 2 x sin 6 x) (sin 2 x cos6x) (sin6 x cos 2 x)
=
=
.
cos 2 x sin 2 x
cos 2 x sin 2 x
sin 2 x cos 2 x
EXAMPLE
57
Solution
Simplify
sin(2 x 6 x)
sin (4 x)
sin 4 x
= 2.
1
sin 4 x
2
This gives us
Trigonometric Identities
191
EXAMPLE
58
Solution
1
(sin 40 cos 40 ) cos 80
=2
cos 20
1
sin 80 cos 80
=4
=
cos 20
160
20
1
sin 160
8
=
cos 20
1
sin 20
1
8
= tan 20
cos 20 8
b. cos 2x
We know that cos (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y.
If x = y this formula becomes
cos (x + x) = (cos x cos x) (sin x sin x), i.e.
cos 2x = cos2 x sin2 x
We can also use the identities sin2 x = 1 cos2 x and cos2 x = 1 sin2 x to obtain two
additional formulas:
cos 2x = 2cos2 x 1
cos 2x = 1 2sin2 x
EXAMPLE
59
Solution
cos 2 x = 2 cos 2 x 1= 2 (
=
EXAMPLE
60
Solution
7 2
7
1
) 1= 2
4
16
1
8
1 cos 2 x
.
1+ cos 2 x
192
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
61
Solution
(cofunctions)
(double-angle formula)
= sin 68 = 2t2 1
c. tan 2x
We know that tan ( x + y) =
tan x + tan y
.
1 tan x tan y
tan x + tan x
, i.e.
1 tan x tan x
tan 2 x =
EXAMPLE
62
Solution
2tan x
1 tan 2 x
4
tan x = . Find tan 2x.
3
tan 2 x =
2 tan x
1 tan 2 x
4
8
8
3
3
=
=
= 3
2
16
7
4
1
1
9
9
3
2
24
7
d. cot 2x
We know that cot ( x + y) =
cot x cot y 1
.
cot x + cot y
cot x cot x 1
, i.e.
cot x + cot x
cot 2 x =
Trigonometric Identities
cot 2 x 1
2cot x
.
193
EXAMPLE
63
Solution
Since tan x =
1
1
we have
cot x = 2, i.e.
cot x
cot x
1 cot 2 x 2
= .
cot x
1
2+ 6
2 6
.
or cot x =
2
2
Since x is an acute angle, the cotangent value must be positive. Since 6 > 2, 2 + 6 is
positive and so cot x =
2+ 6
.
2
e. Half-angle formulas
We have just seen that sin 2x, cos 2x, tan 2x, and cot 2x can be expressed in terms of sin x,
cos x, tan x and cot x respectively. In addition, we can apply the procedure in reverse order to
express sin x, cos x, tan x, and cot x in terms of sin 2x, cos 2x, tan 2x and cot 2x
respectively. For this reason, the double-angle formulas are also called half-angle formulas.
By using the double-angle formula for the cosine function, we can obtain the half-angle
formulas for the sine, tangent and cotangent functions as follows.
x
We know that cos 2x = 2 cos2 x 1. If we replace x with , then
2
x
x
cos 2 = 2 cos 2 1,
2
2
cos x = 2 cos 2
1+ cos x
x
x
1 i.e. cos =
.
2
2
2
(1)
1 cos x
x
x
i.e. sin
.
2
2
2
x
x
x
then cos 2 =1 sin 2 ,
2
2
2
(2)
sin
x
2
2=
tan =
, i.e. tan x = 1 cos x .
2 cos x
1+ cos x
2
1+ cos x
2
2
194
Algebra 9
Similarly,
1+ cos x
x
cos
x
2
2=
cot =
, i.e.
2 sin x
1 cos x
2
2
cot
EXAMPLE
64
cos 2 x =
1+ cos x
x
=
2
1 cos x
1
is given. Find cos x if x is in the first
5
quadrant.
Solution
1 cos 2 x
.
2
EXAMPLE
65
Solution
2
.
5
So sin (22.5 ) =
Trigonometric Identities
2
2
1
2
1 cos 2 x
. Since x is an acute angle, the sine is positive.
2
(cos 45 =
2
)
2
2 2
.
2
195
EXAMPLE
66
Solution
cos x =
So 135
EXAMPLE
67
Solution
1 cos x
x
=
and we take the negative value.
2
1+ cos x
3
1
x
5 =
Hence, tan =
3
2
1+
5
2
5 , i.e. tan x = 1 = 1 .
8
2
4
2
5
Find the values of sin 105 and cos 15 using half-angle formulas.
210
1 cos 210
=
2
2
(cos 210 =
3
)
2
Notice that we take the positive value in the half-angle formula because the sine function is
positive in the second quadrant. So we have
sin 105 =
3
)
2 = 2+ 3 = 2+ 3 .
2
4
2
1 (
Similarly,
cos 15 = cos
30
1+ cos 30
=
.
2
2
(cos 30 =
3
)
2
We take the positive value because the cosine function is positive in the first quadrant. So
cos 15 =
=
196
3
2 = 2+ 3
2
4
1+
2+ 3
.
2
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
68
Solution
Given cot
x
= t, find sin x in terms of t.
2
x t
= in a right triangle, as
2 1
t2 + 1
So sin x = 2
2
2
t +1 t +1
2t
= 2
.
t +1
EXAMPLE
69
Given sin x =
angle.
Solution
x
2
3
x
, find cos
if x is an acute
5
2
C
x
2
5
x
2
D
x
A
9
x DB
=
=
2 DC 3 10
=
Trigonometric Identities
3 10
.
10
197
Check Yourself 16
1. is an acute angle such that sin
3
= . Find sin .
2 5
2
. Find cos 2.
5
1
x
x
is given. Find cos 8x.
sin =
2
2 24
24
25
2.
17
25
3. 7
9
4.
2t
t2 1
5. 23
3. Reduction Formulas
We have already learned how to find trigonometric values by means of a reference angle. In
addition, by using the sum and difference formulas we can derive new relations for the sum
or difference of a variable angle and a quadrantal angle. For example, consider the value
sin( + y) .
2
We know that sin (x + y) = (sin x cos y) + (cos x sin y). If we replace x with , the
2
3
3
3
3
y = cos
cos y + sin
sin y .
, the formula becomes cos
2
2
2
y = sin y .
Hence, cos
2
198
(2)
Algebra 9
As a third example, let us find a trigonometric equivalent of tan (). Since tan () can be
written as tan (2 ) or tan (0 ), we can apply the formula tan ( x y) =
If we replace x with zero, the formula becomes tan (0 y) =
tan x tan y
.
1+(tan x tan y)
tan 0 tan y
. (3)
1+ tan 0 tan y
tan y
and we can write tan ( ) = tan .
1
Result (1), (2) and (3) show how we can write the trigonometric value of the sum or
3
difference of a quadrantal angle and a variable angle (such as + ,
y, + etc. ) as a
2
2
trigonometric value of the single variable angle. In each case we reduced the
Hence, tan ( y) =
trigonometric ratio of a sum or difference to a ratio for a single angle, and for this reason
formulas such as (1), (2) and (3) above are called reduction formulas.
In a similar manner we can derive all of the reduction formulas by substituting quadrantal
angles into the sum and difference formulas.
sin cos
2
cos (0 + ) = cos
cos = sin
2
tan (0 + ) = tan
tan = cot
2
cot (0 + ) = cot
cot = tan
2
Trigonometric Identities
sin + = cos
2
cos ( ) = cos
cos + = sin
2
tan ( ) = tan
tan + = cot
2
cot ( ) = cot
cot + = tan
2
199
sin
= cos
2
cos ( + ) = cos
cos
= sin
2
tan ( + ) = tan
tan
= cot
2
cot ( + ) = cot
cot
= tan
2
sin + = cos
2
cos + = sin
2
tan + = cot
2
cot + = tan
2
Note that reduction formulas are only really useful for problems which ask us to a reduce a
trigonometric ratio with a variable angle such as , , x, y etc. If the ratio is simply a numerical
angle (e.g. 135, 180 etc.) it is easier to calculate the value from the reference angle.
Remember!
Sine and cosine are
cofunctions. The other
cofunction pairs are
tangent and cotangent;
secant and cosecant.
Of course, it is difficult to remember all of the reduction formulas. Instead, we can derive
them from the sum and difference formulas, or we can follow the steps below.
1. Find the primary directed angle for the given angle and determine its quadrant.
2. Determine the sign of the function in the corresponding quadrant.
3. Express the angle or expression as a sum or difference with a suitable quadrantal angle.
4. a. Use the sign from step 2.
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
70
a. sin 585
Solution
c. cos +
2
b. cot 300
d. tan (2 )
2
2
3
3
3. cos +
2
4. a. cos
2
b. cos sin
2
(odd multiple of
c. cos sin
2
5. cos + = sin
2
Trigonometric Identities
201
5. tan(2 ) = tan
EXAMPLE
71
37
Solution
a. We have numerical angle measures. We can use the reference angle or the reduction
process to evaluate each term separately.
cot 240 = cot (180 + 60) = cot 60 =
3
3
3
3
2
2
1
2
3
3
2 1
+
+
3
3
2
2
2 +1
.
2
Algebra 9
b. We have variable angle measures so we need to use the reduction process on each term.
cos (49 ) = cos [(24 2) + ] = cos ( ) = cos
cot (100 + ) = cot [(50 2) + ] = cot (0 + ) = cot
3
71
sin
+ = sin (17 2 )+
+ = sin
+ = cos
2
2
3
37
tan
= tan (10 2 )+
= tan
= cot
2
2
Check Yourself 17
Simplify the expressions.
1. tan 1200 + cot 2010 + sin (390) + cos (780)
3. sin + cos +
2
Answers
1. 0
2. 2cot
Trigonometric Identities
3. cos + sin
4. 0
203
The process is started by measuring the length of an initial baseline between two
surveying stations. Then, using an instrument called a theodolite, a surveyor
measures the angles between these two stations and a third station. The law of sines
is then used to calculate the two other sides of
the triangle formed by the three stations. The
calculated sides are used as baselines, and the
process is repeated over and over to create a
network of triangles. In this method, the only
distance measured is the initial baseline. All
other distances are calculated using the law of
sines.
An expedition to Mount Everest in the
Himalayas once used triangulation to calculate
the height of the peak of Everest to be 8840 m.
Today, using satellites, the same height is
estimated to be 8848 m. The closeness of these
two estimates shows the great accuracy of the
triangulation method.
a theodolite
204
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
2 .4
B. Trigonometric Formulas
terms of tan .
table or a calculator.
a. sin 105
b. cos 15
c. tan 75
d. cos 105
e. tan 165
f. cot 255
g. sin 195
h. cot 345
and x 0,
5
2
5
b. cos x =
and csc x < 0
13
7
and x ,
c. tan x =
24
2
a. sin x =
2
1
and cos y =
3
4
value of each expression.
14. sin x =
a. sin (x + y)
b. sin (x y)
c. cos (x + y)
d. cos (x y)
e. tan (x + y)
f. cot (x y)
3
. Evaluate the expressions.
5
b. cos (2x + y)
a. tan (x + y)
tan y =
c. sin (x + y)
d. cos (x 2y)
f. sin (x + 2y)
1
and
4
2
and sin x > 0
3
x
x
x
and tan
from the
2
2
2
a. sin x =
and x 0,
5
2
b. cos x =
3
3
and x ,
5
2
c. csc x = 3 and x ,
2
16. Simplify the expressions.
b. cos (x + y) + cos (x y)
c. sin (x + 30) + sin (x 30)
d. sin (x + y) sin (x y)
Trigonometric Identities
d. tan x = 1 and x 0,
2
e. sec x =
3
3
and x , 2
2
2
b. cos 75 + cos 15
g. cos cos 5
12
12
h. sin 3 sin
8
b. sin x sin 4x
c. cos 4x cos 6x
d. cos 9x + cos 2x
e. sin 2x sin 7x
f. sin 3x + sin 4x
h. cos
5x
x
cos
2
2
a. 1 + cos x = 2cos2
d. 1 sin x = 2 cos 2 +
4 2
2 sin + x
4
e. 1+ tan x =
cos x
2 sin x
4
f. 1 tan x =
cos x
g.
1 tan x
= tan + x
1+ tan x
4
2 sin + x
4
h. 1+ cot x =
sin x
2 sin x
4
i. 1+ cot x =
sin x
206
Algebra 9
Real number sequences are strings of numbers. They play an important role in our everyday
lives. For example, the following sequence:
20, 20.5, 21, 22, 23.4, 23.6, ...
gives the temperature measured in a city at midday for five consecutive days. It looks like the
temperature is rising, but it is not possible to exactly predict the future temperature.
The sequence:
64, 32, 16, 8,
is the number of teams which play in each round of a tournament so that at the end of each
game one team is eliminated and the other qualifies for the next round. Now we can easily
predict the next numbers: 4, 2, and 1. Since there will be one champion, the sequence will
end at 1, that is, the sequence has a finite number of terms. Sequences may be finite in
number or infinite.
Look at the following sequence:
1000, 1100, 1210,
This is the total money owned by an investor at the end of each successive year. The capital
increases by 10% every year. You can predict the next number in the sequence to be 1331.
Each successive term here is 110% of, or 1.1 times, the previous term.
A. SEQUENCES
1. Definition
If someone asked you to list the squares of all the natural numbers, you might begin by writing
By the set of natural
numbers we mean all
positive integers and
denote this set by .
That is, = {1, 2, 3, ...}.
A function is a relation
between two sets A and
B that assigns to each
element of set A exactly
one element of set B.
Definition
where f(n) = n . Here f(1) is the first term, f(2) is the second term, and so on. f(n) = n2 is a
function of n, defined in the set of natural numbers.
sequence
A function which is defined in the set of natural numbers is called a sequence.
However, we do not usually use functional notation to describe sequences. Instead, we
denote the first term by a1, the second term by a2, and so on. So for the above list
a1 = 1, a2 = 4, a3 = 9, a4 = 16, a5 = 25, a6 = 36, ..., an = n2, ...
Here,
Since this is just a matter of notation, we can use another letter instead of the letter a. For example,
we can also use bn, cn, dn, etc. as the name for the general term of a sequence.
Notation
We denote a sequence by (an), where an is written inside brackets. We write the general term
of a sequence as an, where an is written without brackets. For the above example, if we write
the general term, we write an = n2.
If we want to list the terms, we write (an) = (1, 4, 9, 16, ..., n2, ...).
Sometimes we can also use a shorthand way to write a sequence:
(an) = (n2 + 4n + 1) means the sequence (an) with general term an = n2 + 4n + 1.
208
Algebra 9
Note
An expression like a2.6 is nonsense since we cannot talk about the 2.6th term of a sequence.
Remember that a sequence is a function which is defined in the set of natural numbers, and
2.6 is not a natural number. Clearly, expressions like a0, a1 are also meaningless. We say that
such terms are undefined.
Note
In a sequence, n should always be a natural number, but the value of an may be any real
number depending on the formula for the general term of the sequence.
Example
Solution
Write the first five terms of the sequence with general term
Solution
1
.
n
Since we are looking for the first five terms, we just recalculate the general term for
n = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, which gives 1,
Example
an =
1 1 1 1
, , , .
2 3 4 5
4n 5
, find a5, a2, a100.
2n
We just have to recalculate the formula for an choosing instead of n the numbers 5, 2, and
3
395 79
100. So a5 = , and a100 =
=
. Clearly, a2 is undefined, since 2 is not a natural
2
200 40
number.
Example
Solution
Find a suitable general term bn for the sequence whose first four terms are
1 2 3 4
, , , .
2 3 4 5
We need to find a pattern. Notice that the numerator of each fraction is equal to the term
position and the denominator is one more than the term position, so we can write bn =
n
.
n +1
Check Yourself 1
1. Write the first five terms of the sequence whose general term is cn = (1)n.
2. Find a suitable general term an for the sequence whose first four terms are 2, 4, 6, 8.
3. Given the sequence with general term bn = 2n + 3, find b5, b0, and b43.
Answers
1. 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 2. 2n 3. 13, undefined, 89
Sequences and Series
209
Example
Solution
Example
Solution
Is an =
2 n +1
a general term of a sequence? Why?
n2
Is an =
4 n
a general term of a sequence? Why?
2 n +1
4 n
0 to be true
2 n +1
1
for any natural number n. If we solve this equation for n, the solution set is ( , 4], i.e. n is
2
1
between and 4, inclusive. When we take the natural numbers in this solution set, we get
2
{1, 2, 3, 4}, which means that only a1, a2, a3, a4 are defined. So an is not the general term of
a sequence.
Example
Solution
Example
Is an =
n +1
a general term of a sequence? If yes, find a1 + a2 + a3.
2n 1
n +1
1
is not meaningful only when n = . Since an is defined for any natural number,
2n 1
2
it is the general term of a sequence. Choosing n = 1, 2, 3 we get a1 = 2, a2 = 1, a3 = 0.8.
So a1 + a2 + a3 = 3.8.
Solution
a.
b. 17
bn = 25
2n + 5 = 25
n = 10
10th term
210
b.
c. 96
bn = 17
2n + 5 = 17
c.
bn = 96
2n + 5 = 96
n=6
n = 45.5
6th term
not a term
Algebra 9
Check Yourself 2
1. Is an =
3n +1
a general term of a sequence? Why?
n+ 2
3n 1
7
is
?
5n +7
12
Example
Solution
n2 6 n 7
are negative?
3n 2
We are looking for the number of values of n for which an < 0. In other words we should find
the solution set for
n2 6 n 7
< 0 in the set of natural numbers. Solving the inequality,
3n 2
2
we get ( , 1) ( , 7). The natural numbers in this solution set are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
3
Therefore, six terms of this sequence are negative.
B. TYPES OF SEQUENCE
1. Finite and Infinite Sequences
A sequence may contain a finite or infinite number of terms.
For example the sequence (an) = (1, 4, 9, ..., n2) contains n terms, which is a finite number
of terms. The sequence (bn) = (1, 4, 9, ..., n2, ...) contains infinitely many terms.
If a sequence contains a countable number of terms, then we say it is a finite sequence.
If a sequence contains infinitely many terms, then we say it is an infinite sequence.
Example
211
Solution
Note
In this book, if we do not say a sequence is finite, then it is an infinite sequence.
2. Monotone Sequences
If each term of a sequence is greater than the previous term, then the sequence is called an
increasing sequence.
Symbolically, (an) is an increasing sequence if an+1 > an.
If an+1 an, then (an) is a nondecreasing sequence.
If each term of a sequence is less than the previous term, then that sequence is called a
decreasing sequence.
Symbolically (an) is a decreasing sequence if an+1 < an.
If an+1 an, then (an) is a nonincreasing sequence.
In general any increasing, nondecreasing, decreasing, or nonincreasing sequence is called a
monotone sequence.
For example, the sequence 10, 8, 6, 4, ... is a decreasing sequence since each consecutive
term is less than the previous one. Therefore, it is a monotone sequence.
The sequence 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, ... is a nondecreasing sequence, because the first two terms are
equal. It is also a monotone sequence.
Consider the sequence 4, 1, 0, 1, 4, ... . Obviously we cannot put this sequence into any of
the categories of sequence defined above. Therefore, it is not monotone.
Note
We can rewrite the above criteria for increasing and decreasing sequences in a different way:
If an+1 an > 0, then we have an increasing sequence.
If an+1 an < 0, then we have a decreasing sequence.
212
Algebra 9
Example
10
Solution
Prove that the sequence (an) with general term an = 2n is an increasing sequence.
If an = 2n, then an+1 = 2(n + 1) = 2n + 2, and so an+1 an = 2n + 2 2n = 2.
Since 2 > 0, (an) is an increasing sequence.
Example
11
Solution
If bn =
1
is a decreasing sequence.
n +1
1
1
, then bn+1 =
.
n +1
n+ 2
bn+1 bn =
1
1
1
=
n + 2 n +1 ( n +1)( n + 2)
Example
12
1
< 0.
( n +1)( n + 2)
Solution
The peak point of a
parabola given by
2
f(x) = ax + bx + c is
b , f ( b ) .
2a
2a
y
13
12
9
6
3
1 2 34 5 67 8
3
6
f(x)=x2+8x3
213
Check Yourself 3
1. State if the following sequences are finite or infinite.
1
a. The sequence with general term cn =
.
n +1
b. 3, 6, 9, ..., 54
c. 3, 6, 9, ...
2. Prove that (an) = (2 5n) is a decreasing sequence.
3. Classify the following sequences as increasing or decreasing.
n +1
4
b. ( bn ) = ( )
c. ( cn ) = (
d. (dn) = (n2 4n)
a. (an) = (2n + 1)
)
n
2n 8
4. For which term(s) does the sequence (cn) = (n2 5n + 7) take its minimum value?
Hint: Consider the nearest natural x-coordinates to the minimum of the graph of
f(x) = (x2 5x + 7).
Answers
1. a. infinite b. finite c. infinite
3. Piecewise Sequences
If the general term of a sequence is defined by more than one formula, then it is called a
piecewise sequence.
For example, the sequence with general term
1
, n is even
n
an =
2
n +1, n is odd
is a piecewise sequence.
Example
13
Solution
1
, n is even
n
Write the first four terms of the piecewise sequence with general term an =
.
2
n +1, n is odd
1
2
since n is odd, and to find a2 and a4 we use
since n is even.
n
n +1
2
1
2
So a1 = 1, a2 = , a3 = , and a4 = .
3
3
5
214
Algebra 9
Example
14
n2 5n , n <10
,
Given the piecewise sequence with general term an =
, n 10
n 8
a. find a20.
b. find a1.
c. find the term which is equal to 0.
Solution
or
n 8 = 0 (for n 10)
n(n 5) = 0
n = 8 10
n = 0 or n = 5
So a5 = 0.
15
Given a1 = 4 and an + 1 = an + 3,
a. find a2.
b. find the general term of the sequence.
Solution
a. Note that choosing n = 2 will not help us to find a2 since we will get an equation like
a3 = a2 + 3, which needs a3 to get a2.
But if we choose n = 1, we will get a2 = a1 + 3. Using a1 = 4, we find a2 = 4 + 3 = 7.
b. a2 = a1 + 3
a3 = a2 + 3 = a1 + 3 + 3
a4 = a3 + 3 = a1 + 3 + 3 + 3
a5 = a4 + 3 = a1 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3
.
.
.
an = a1 + (n 1) 3
an = 4 + (n 1) 3
So the general term is an = 3n + 1.
215
Example
16
Solution
Given f1 = 1, f2 = 1, fn = fn 2 + fn 1 (for n 3), find the first six terms of the sequence.
When we consider the general term, we notice that it is not possible to calculate a terms
value unless we know the two previous terms. Since we are given the first and second terms,
with the help of the general term we can find the third term.
Choosing n = 3, the formula for general term becomes f3 = f1 + f2 = 1 + 1 = 2. Now it is
possible to find a4, and then by the same procedure a5 and a6.
f4 = f2 + f3 = 1 + 2 = 3
f5 = f 3 + f 4 = 2 + 3 = 5
f6 = f 4 + f 5 = 3 + 5 = 8
The first six terms are 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, 8.
Since recursively defined sequences have terms which depend on previous ones like a chain,
we calculate the terms one by one to find the desired term. In the above example, unless we
find a direct formula for the general term (is it possible?), it will take too much time and
effort to find f1000.
216
Algebra 9
We can make a picture showing the Fibonacci numbers if we start with two small squares whose sides are each one
unit long next to each other. Then we draw a square with side length two units (1 + 1 units) next to both of these.
We can now draw a new square which touches the square with side one unit and the square with side two units,
and therefore has side three units. Then we draw another square touching the two previous squares (side five
units), and so on. We can continue adding squares around the picture, each new square having a side which is as
long as the sum of the sides of the two previous squares. Now we can draw a spiral by connecting the quarter
circles in each square, as shown on the next page. This is a spiral (the Fibonacci Spiral). A similar curve to this
occurs in nature as the shape of a nautilus.
Sequences and Series
217
3
5
2
1
1
13
8
The ancient Greeks also considered a line segment divided into two parts such that the ratio of the shorter part of
length one unit to the longer part is the same as the ratio of the longer part to the whole segment.
1
1+ 5
1
x
This leads to the equation =
whose positive solution is x =
. Thus, the segment shown is divided into
2
x 1+ x
the golden ratio!
A rectangle in which the ratio of one side to the other gives the golden ratio is called a golden rectangle. The Golden
Rectangle is a unique and a very important shape in mathematics. It appears in nature and music, and is also often
used in art and architecture. The Golden Rectangle is believed to be one of the most pleasing and beautiful shapes
for the human eye.
x
y
x
y
The golden ratio is frequently used in architecture.
To construct a golden rectangle, draw a square ABCD and then find the middle
point M of the base AB. Draw a line from M to C. Using M as the center point,
rotate the line MC until it overlaps AB. Name this new line ME. Draw a vertical
up from point E until it intersects the extension of line DC and label that
intersection as point F. The new rectangle AEFD is a golden rectangle.
Example
17
Solution
Solution
This time we are given the fifth term and the third term is required. This means we should
think backwards. That is, first we should find a4 and then a3.
18
Choosing n = 5, the formula for general term becomes 7a4 = 3a5, i.e. a4 =
Example
9
.
7
18
. Now it is
7
a1 = 1
a2 = a1 + 2
a3 = a2 + 3
a4 = a3 + 4
.
.
.
a99 = a98 + 99
a100 = a99 + 100
219
(1)
(2)
or
Check Yourself 4
2n + 1
1. Given an =
n<6
n 1
6 n 13,
n > 13
1
and an = an+1 an1 (for n 2), find a5.
2
3. Given a1 = 1 and an = 2an1 + 1 (for n 2), which term of the sequence is equal to 63?
Answers
1. a13 biggest, a1 smallest 2. 3.5 3. 6th
220
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
3 .1
A. Sequences
an =
sequence or not.
a. 3n 76
b.
d.
4
2
n 4
e.
g.
n5
h.
n
n+ 2
13
4
c.
f.
n2 + 2 n
i.
2 n +1
2n 1
(1)n
1
n3
n2 n 2
n2
c. 0, 3, 8, 15
1
8
27
d. , ,
5
7
9
2n + 1
n even
n2
n odd
find a4 + a7.
e. 2, 6, 12, 20, 30
B. Types of Sequence
n2 2 n
and a5 = 5, find k.
1 k+ n
a. an = 4n 17 is increasing.
1
b. bn = 25 ( )n is decreasing.
5
b. an =
3n +1
, find the first three terms and a33
n +7
3n 7
is
n+ 2
12. Find the biggest and smallest terms (if they exist)
term an =
3n 7
1
are less than ?
3n +5
5
b. bn = n2 + 4n + 7
3n 5
2 n +1
221
a. a1 = 1, an+1 = 2an
find
b. b1 = 3, bn+1 = 5 + bn
( n +1)!
3n
an+1
.
an
c. a1 = 3, an = (2n + 1)an 1
term an =
b. bn = 2
3n 72
are integers?
n
1
c. cn = 8 ( ) n
2
2a + 3
15. Given a sequence with an+1 = n
and a1 = 3,
2
term an =
n3 + 4n2 + 3n +1
are integers?
n+ 2
find a29.
n+2
an and
n
bn 3
3n 2
is
increasing.
Mixed Problems
17. Given the sequences with general terms
an = (2)n + 2, bn = 4 + 4n, cn = 2 (2)n, find
general term cn =
2003 n + p
is increasing.
2004
an
an 1
( n! = n (n 1) (n 2) ... 3 2 1 where n )
222
O L Y G O N A L U M B E R S
At the beginning of this book we looked at the sequence 1, 4, 9, 16, 25, 36, ... . We
call the numbers in this sequence square numbers. We can generate the square
numbers by creating a sequence of nested squares like the one on the right.
Starting from a common vertex, each square has sides one unit longer than the
previous square. When we count the number of points in each successive
square, we get the sequence of square numbers
(first square = 1 point, second square = 4 points, third square = 9 points, etc.).
36
25
16
9
4
1
Polygonal numbers are numbers which form sequences like the one above for different polygons. The Pythagoreans
named these numbers after the polygons that defined them.
Triangular numbers
10
15
21
16
25
Square numbers
1
Pentagonal numbers
1
12
22
35
Polygonal numbers have many interesting relationships between them. For example, the sum of any two consecutive
triangular numbers is a square number, and eight times any triangular number plus one is always a square number.
Can you fnd any more patterns? Can you find the general term for each set of polygonal numbers?
Sequences and Series
223
A. ARITHMETIC SEQUENCES
1. Definition
Lets look at the sequence 6, 10, 14, 18,
Obviously the difference between each term is equal to
4 and the sequence can be written as an+1 = an + 4
where a1 = 6.
For the sequence 23, 21, 19, the formula will be
an+1 = an 2 where a1 = 23.
In these examples, the difference between consecutive
terms in each sequence is the same. We call sequences
with this special property arithmetic sequences.
arithmetic sequence
Definition
If a sequence (an) has the same difference d between its consecutive terms, then it is called
an arithmetic sequence.
In other words, (an) is arithmetic if an+1 = an + d such than n , d . We call d the
common difference of the arithmetic sequence. In this book, from now on we will use
an to denote general term of an arithmetic sequence and d (the first letter of the Latin word
differentia, meaning difference) for the common difference.
If d is positive, we say the arithmetic sequence is increasing. If d is negative, we say the
arithmetic sequence is decreasing. What can you say when d is zero?
EXAMPLE
19
State whether the following sequences are arithmetic or not. If a sequence is arithmetic, find
the common difference.
a. 7, 10, 13, 16,
Solution
EXAMPLE
20
a. arithmetic, d = 3 b. arithmetic, d = 5
c. 1, 4, 9, 16,
d. 6, 6, 6, 6,
c. not arithmetic
d. arithmetic, d = 0
State whether the sequences with the following general terms are arithmetic or not. If a
sequence is arithmetic, find the common difference.
a. an = 4n 3
224
b. 3, 2, 7, 12,
b. an = 2n
c. an = n2 n
2
d. an = n +5 n + 4
n+ 4
Algebra 9
Solution
Note
The general term of an arithmetic sequence is linear.
2. General Term
Since arithmetic sequences have many applications, it is
much better to express the general term directly, instead of
recursively. The formula is derived as follows:
If (an) is arithmetic, then we only know that an+1 = an + d. Let us write a few terms.
a1 = a1
a2 = a1 + d
a3 = a2 + d = (a1 + d) + d = a1 + 2d
a4 = a3 + d = (a1 + 2d) + d = a1 + 3d
a5 = a1 + 4d
.
.
.
an = a1 + (n 1)d
This is the general term of an arithmetic sequence.
225
Algebra 9
21
Solution
3, 2, 7 are the first three terms of an arithmetic sequence (an). Find the twentieth term.
We know that a1 = 3 and d = a3 a2 = a2 a1 = 5. Using the general term formula,
an = a1 + (n 1)d
a20 = 3 + (20 1) 5 = 92.
EXAMPLE
22
Solution
(an) is an arithmetic sequence with a1 = 4, a8 = 25. Find the common difference and a101.
Using the general term formula,
an = a1 + (n 1)d
a8 = a1 + 7d
25 = 4 + 7d. So we have d = 3.
a101 = a1 + (100 1)d = 4 + 100 3 = 304
EXAMPLE
23
Solution
EXAMPLE
24
Solution
226
an a1
+1, which
d
EXAMPLE
25
Solution
Therefore, n =
Check Yourself 5
1. Is the sequence with general term an = 5n + 9 an arithmetic sequence? Why?
2. 6, 2, 2 are the first three terms of an arithmetic sequence (an). Find the 30th term.
3. (an) is an arithmetic sequence with a1 = 7, a10 = 70. Find the common difference and a101.
4. (an) is an arithmetic sequence with a1 = 1 and common difference 9. Which term of this
sequence is 89?
5. How many three-digit numbers are divisible by 30?
Answers
1. yes; linear formula 2. 110 3. 7; 707
4. 11th
5. 30
26
Solution
(an) is an arithmetic sequence with a11 = 34 and common difference 3. Find a3.
Using the general term formula,
an
a11
34
a1
a3
227
=
=
=
=
=
a1
a1
a1
4
a1
+ (n 1)d
+ (11 1) 3
+ 30
+ 2d = 4 + 6, so a3 = 10.
Algebra 9
In this example, we calculated the first term of the sequence (a1) from a11, then used this
value to find a3. However, there is a quicker way to solve this problem: in general, if we know
the common difference and any term of an arithmetic sequence, we can find the required
term without finding the first term. Look at the calculation:
If we know ap and d, to find an we can write:
an = a1 + (n 1)d
(1)
ap = a1 + (p 1)d
(2)
27
Solution
EXAMPLE
28
Solution
(an) is an arithmetic sequence with a5 = 14 and a10 = 34. Find the common difference.
Using the advanced general term formula,
an = ap + (n p)d
a10 = a5 + (10 5)d
34 = 14 + 5d
d = 4.
(an) is an arithmetic sequence with a9 a2 = 42. Find a10 a7.
Using the advanced general term formula,
a9 = a2 + 7d
a9 a2 = 7d
42 = 7d
d = 6.
Therefore, a10 = a7 + 3d
a10 a7 = 3 6 = 18.
228
EXAMPLE
29
Solution
EXAMPLE
30
Solution
cb
.
k +1
We insert five numbers in increasing order between 12 and 42 such that all the numbers
form an arithmetic sequence. Find the third number of this sequence.
If we begin with two numbers and insert five numbers, the sequence has seven numbers in
total. Let us call the first number a1, the second a2, and so on. We can now write the
problem differently: given an arithmetic sequence (an) with a1 = 12, a7 = 42, find a3.
Using the general term formula,
a7 = a1 + 6d
42 = 12 + 6d
d=5
a3 = a1 + 2d
a3 = 12 + 10
a3 = 22.
EXAMPLE
31
Solution
(1)
(2)
Algebra 9
(1)
ap + k = ap + kd.
(2)
Note that in the previous example, a8 was at equal distance from a2 and a14. (Could we solve
the problem if we were given not a8 but a10?)
x+ y
2
where k < p.
For example, all the following equalities will hold in an arithmetic sequence:
a2 =
a1 + a3
since a2 is in the middle of a1 and a3
2
a5 + a7 a1 + a11 a4 + ax
=
=
2
2
2
a12 + a20
= ay
(y must be 16)
2
a6 =
ap k + ap+k
( x must be 8)
32
Solution
EXAMPLE
a2 =
a1 + a3
5+19
and x =
=12. Therefore, x is 12 if the sequence is arithmetic.
2
2
Note
Three numbers a, b, c form an arithmetic sequence if and only if b =
Sequences and Series
a+ c
.
2
230
EXAMPLE
33
Solution
Find the general term an for the arithmetic sequence with a5 + a21 = 106 and a9 = 37.
a5 + a21
106
= a13 =
. So a13 = 53.
2
2
Using the advanced general term formula,
a13 = a9 + 4d
53 = 37 + 4d
d = 4.
To write the general term we can choose a9 or a13. Let us choose a9, then using the advanced
general term formula we get
an = a9 + (n 9)d
an = 37 + (n 9) 4
an = 4n + 1.
Check Yourself 6
1. (an) is an arithmetic sequence with a17 = 41 and common difference 4. Find a3.
2. (an) is an arithmetic sequence with a5 = 19, a14 = 55. Find the common difference.
3. Fill in the blanks to form an arithmetic sequence: __ , __ , __ , __ , 2, __ , __ , __ , 8.
4. Find x if x, 4, 19 form an arithmetic sequence.
5. Find the general term an for the arithmetic sequence with a3 + a19 = 98, d = 7.
Answers
1. 97 2. 4 3. 2.5, 1, 0.5 and then 3.5, 5, 6.5
EXAMPLE
34
Solution
4. 11
5. 7n 28
Given an arithmetic sequence (an) with a1 = 100 and a22 as the first negative term, how many
integer values can d take?
Lets convert the problem into algebraic language:
a1 =100 a22 < 0
,
since a22 is the first negative term.
d
a21 0
Since we are looking for the common difference (d), we need to express the above system of
inequalities in terms of d:
a22 < 0
, that is
a21 0
a1 + 21d < 0
, so
a
d
+
20
0
100
21 .
d 5
d<
The only integer that is in the solution set for the above inequalities is 5, so d can take only
one integer value (5).
231
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
35
Solution
(
a
+
d
)
(
a
+
3
d
)
(
a
+5
d
)
=
168
1
1
1
( a1 + d) ( a1 + 3 d) ( a1 +5 d) = 16 8.
(1)
(2 )
232
EXAMPLE
36
Solution
Given the arithmetic sequence with general term an = 3n + 1, find the sum of first three terms.
S3 = a1 + a2 + a3 = 4 + 7 + 10 = 21.
How could we find S100 in the above example? Calculating terms and finding their sums takes
time and effort for large sums. Since arithmetic sequences are of special interest and
importance, we need a more efficient way of calculating the sums of arithmetic sequences.
The following theorem meets our needs:
Theorem
a1 + a n
n.
2
Sn = a1 + a2 + ... + an 1 + an or
Sn = an + an 1 + ... + a2 + a1.
Adding these equations side by side,
2Sn = ( a1 + an )+( a2 + an 1 )+...+( an 1 + a2 )+( an + a1)
2Sn = ( a1 + an )+( a1 + d + an d)+...+( an d+ a1+ d)+( a n + a1)
2Sn = ( a1 + an )+( a1 + an )+...+( a1 + an )+( a1+ a n)
n times
2Sn = ( a1 + an ) n
Sn =
EXAMPLE
37
Solution
EXAMPLE
38
Solution
a1 + an
n.
2
a1 + a6
6 = (2+17) 3 = 57.
2
233
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
39
Solution
14 = 56 + 10d, so d = 7 and
a15 = a1+ 14d = 56 + 14 (7) = 42.
Therefore, S15 =
EXAMPLE
40
Solution
56 42
15 =105.
2
If 5 + ... + 49 = 616 is the sum of the terms of a finite arithmetic sequence, how many
terms are there in the sequence?
Let us convert the problem into algebraic language:
a1 = 5, ap = 49, and Sp = 616, and we need to find p.
Using the sum formula,
Sp =
a1 + ap
2
5+ 49
p, so p = 28. So 28 numbers were added.
2
EXAMPLE
41
Solution
2 a1 +( n 1)d
n.
2
2 (7)+(15 1) d
14+14 d
1
15, that is, 90 =
15, so d = .
2
2
7
234
EXAMPLE
42
Solution
Check Yourself 7
1. Given an arithmetic sequence with a1 = 4 and a10 = 15, find S10.
2. Given an arithmetic sequence with a13 = 26 and d = 2, find S13.
3. Given an arithmetic sequence with a1 = 9 and S8 = 121, find d.
4. Find the sum of all the multiples of 3 between 20 and 50.
Answers
1. 95 2. 494 3. 1.75
EXAMPLE
43
Solution
4. 345
(an) is a sequence of consecutive integers with first term 3 and sum 52. How many terms are
there in this sequence?
Here a1 = 3, d = 1, Sn = 52, n = ?.
Using the alternative sum formula,
2a1 +( n 1) d
n
2
6+( n 1) 1
52 =
n
2
n2 +5 n 104 = 0.
Sn =
EXAMPLE
44
Solution
(an) is an arithmetic sequence with S11 S10 = 43 and S15 S14 = 87. Find d.
Note that the difference between S11 and S10 is just a11. Therefore, a11 = 43 and a15 = 87.
a15 = a11 + 4d
87 = 43 + 4d
d = 11.
235
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
45
Solution
S8 = 4
a1 + a12
12 = 30
2
, so
a1 + a8 8 = 4
2
a1 + a1 + 11d = 5
a1 + a1 + 7d = 1
which means
a1 = 3
d=1
Therefore, a3 = a1 + 2d = 1.
EXAMPLE
46
Solution
Find the general term of the arithmetic sequence (an) if the sum of the first n terms is 3n2 4n.
a1 + an
a + an
n, so 3 n 2 4 n = 1
n.
2
2
a + an
Since n 0, 3 n 4 = 1
, so an = 6 n 8 a1.
2
Sn =
2. Applied Problems
EXAMPLE
47
Solution
The population of a city increased by 4200 in the year 2004. The rate of population growth is
expected to decrease by 20 people per year. What is the citys expected total population
growth between 2004 and 2014 inclusive?
Note that the rate of population growth in the city is decreasing. Here, symbolically we have:
a1 = 4200 (the population growth in the first year that is to be included in the total)
d = 20 (the difference between the population growth for consecutive years)
S11 = ? (the total population growth in eleven years from 2004 to 2014 inclusive)
S11 =
2a1 +10 d
2 4200+10 (20)
11=
11= 45100.
2
2
48
Solution
Every hour an antique clock chimes as many times as the hour. How many times does it chime
between 8:00 a.m. and 7:00 p.m. inclusive?
Note that the number of chimes in the given time interval will not form an arithmetic
sequence since after noon it will restart from 1. But until noon and after noon we have two
independent finite arithmetic sequences. Therefore, let us define two sequences and deal
with them independently.
236
8+12
p, so S5 =
5= 50.
2
2
Now consider the sequence after noon.
Sp =
1+7
q, so S7 =
7= 28
2
2
Now Sp + Sq = ? (total number of chimes).
Sp + Sq = 50 + 28 = 78. Therefore, the clock chimes 78 times.
Sq =
Obviously, direct calculation would be a much faster way to find the correct answer in this
problem, but the idea used here will be necessary in more complicated problems.
EXAMPLE
49
Solution
A farmer picks 120 tomatoes on the first day of the harvest, and each day after, he picks 40
more tomatoes than the previous day. How many days will it take for the farmer to pick a total
of 3000 tomatoes?
We can describe this situation with the help of
arithmetic sequence notation:
a1 = 120, d = 40, Sn = 3000, n = ?
2a1 +( n 1) d
n
2
2 120+( n 1) 40
3000 =
n
2
n2 +5 n 150 = 0.
Sn =
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
50
Solution
For a period of 42 days, each day a mailbox received four more letters than the previous day.
The total number of letters received during the first 24 days of the period is equal to the total
number received during the last 18 days of the period. How many letters were received during
the entire period?
Obviously d = 4 and we are looking for S42. We can express the number of letters received
during the first 24 days by S24. But note that the number of letters received during the last
18 days of the period is not S18. In fact, the number of letters received during the last 18 days
is equal to the difference between the number of letters received during the entire period and
the number of letters received during the first 24 days, so:
S24 = S42 S24 or 2 S24 = S42.
Using the alternative sum formula,
2
2 a1 + 23d
2 a + 41d
24 = 1
42
2
2
2a1 + 41d
2 206+ 41 4
42 =
42 =12096.
2
2
Check Yourself 8
1. Starting from 10 inclusive, is it possible to have a sum of 360 by adding a sequence of
consecutive even numbers?
2. (an) is an arithmetic sequence with S10 = 75 and S6 = 9. Find S4.
3. Find the common difference of an arithmetic sequence if the sum of the first n terms of
the sequence is given by the formula n2 2n.
4. A free-falling object drops 9.8 meters further during each second than it did during the
previous second. If an object falls 4.9 meters during the first second of its descent, how
far will it fall in five seconds?
Answers
1. yes 2. 6 3. 2
Sequences and Series
4. 122.5 meters
238
EXAMPLE
51
Solution
a1, a2, ..., a21 form an arithmetic sequence. The sum of the odd-numbered terms is 15 more
than sum of the even-numbered terms and a20 = 3a9. Find a12.
Since we are talking about two different sums, well divide this sequence into two different
finite sequences.
Let bn denote the odd-numbered terms with common difference 2d, so (bn) = (a1, a3, ..., a21),
and let Snb denote the sum of first n terms of this sequence. Note that for this sequence
n = 11.
Let cn denote the even-numbered terms with common difference 2d, so (cn) = (a2, a4, ..., a20),
and let Snc denote the sum of first n terms of this sequence. Note that for this sequence
n = 10.
Here, note that both (bn) and (cn) are arithmetic sequences, and both have the same
common difference which is twice the common difference of (an).
b1
b2
... b10
b11
a1 a2
a3
a4
c1
c2
... a19
a20
a21
...
c10
Now, let us write what we are given in a system of two variables since we have two equations:
c1 + c10
b1 + b11
b
c
S11
10 =15
S10
=15
2 11
2
, that is
a20 = 3a9
a1 +19d = 3 ( a1 +8 d)
( a + d)+( a1 + d +18 d)
( a1 )+( a1 + 20 d)
11 1
10 =15
2
2
a1 +19d = 3 ( a1 +8 d)
a1 +10 d =15
a1 = 5
, so
.
d = 2
2 a1 +5 d = 0
EXAMPLE
52
Solution
239
Find the sum of all the three-digit numbers which are not divisible by 13.
First of all we should realize that all the three-digit numbers which are not divisible by 13 do not
form an arithmetic sequence, so we cannot use any sum formula. It will also take a long time to
find and add the numbers. Therefore, let us look for a different way to express this sum.
Algebra 9
Note that all the three-digit numbers form an arithmetic sequence, and all the three-digit
numbers that are divisible by 13 form another arithmetic sequence, which means we can
calculate these sums. Realizing that the sum we are asked to find is the difference between the
sum of all three-digit numbers and the sum of all three-digit numbers that are divisible by 13,
we are ready to formulize the solution.
Let Sn denote the sum of all three-digit numbers, so
a1 =100, d =1, an 999, Sn = ?.
an = a1 +( n 1)d, that is 999 =100+ n 1, and so n= 900.
Sn =
a1 + an
100+999
n, so S900 =
900 = 494550.
2
2
Now let Sn denote the sum of all three-digit numbers which are divisible by 13. So,
b1 = 104 (the first three-digit number that is divisible by 13), bn = 988 (why?), Sn = ?.
bn = b1 + (n 1) d, so 988 = 104 + (n 1) 13 and n = 69.
Sn =
b1 + bn
104+988
n, so S69 =
69 = 37674.
2
2
We are looking for S900 S69 = 494550 37674 = 456 876. This is the sum of all the
three-digit numbers which are not divisible by 13.
240
EXERCISES
3 .2
A. Arithmetic Sequences
b. d = 3, a1 = 1
c. d = 0, a1 = 0
3
d. d = , a1 = 3
2
e. d = 1, a1 = 0
f. d = 7, a1 = 2
a.
2
1
2
a. ( an ) = ( ,
,
)
b b(1 b) 1 b
e. a5 = 8, a37 = 8
f. a6 = 6, a20 = 34
g. a3 = 1, a5 = 2
a4 +?
2
b. a1 = 4, a4 = 10
b. a6 =
g. d = b + 3, a1 = 2b + 7
a. a1 = 3, a2 = 5
a12 + a20
=?
2
b. (an) = (5 + 2b, 15 + b, 31 b)
c. (an) = [(a + 1)3, (a3 + 3a + b), (a 1)3]
h. a2 = 2x y, a8 = x + 2y
b. a17 = 41, d = 4
241
b. a1 = 3, a7 = 27, S40 = ?
c. a1 = 7, S16 = 332, d = ?
5
d. d = , S34 =1173, a1 = ?
3
e. a1 = 2, an+1 = an 2, S23 = ?
f.
3
1
a1 = , d = , Sp =1700, p = ?
2
2
h. an = 5n 10, S7 = ?
i. a1 = 5, ap = 20, Sp = 250, p = ?
j. S60 = 3840, a1 = 5, a61 = ?
k. a1 = 3, a10 a7 = 6, S20 = ?
l. a1 = 1, S22 S18 = 238, a7 = ?
the sum of the first nine terms and the sum of the
first seven terms is 20. Find the sum of the first
sixteen terms.
242
243
Mixed Problems
1
1
1
also form
,
,
b+ c c+ a a+ b
an arithmetic sequence.
Sn + 3 3Sn + 2 + 3Sn + 1 Sn = 0.
44 . Solve
x 1 x 2 x 3 x 4
x 576 1
2 + 2 2 +...
= .
2
x
x
x
x
x2
2
244
A magic square is an arrangement of natural numbers in a square matrix so that the sum of the
numbers in each column, row, and diagonal is the same number (the magic number). The
number of cells on one side of the square is called the order of the magic square.
Here is one of the earliest known magic squares:
4
It is a third order magic square constructed by using the numbers 1, 2, 3, ..., 9. Notice that the numbers in each
row, column, and diagonal add up to the number 15, and 1, 2, 3, ,9 form an arithmetic sequence. This magic
Shu magic square.
square was possibly constructed in 2200 B.C. in China. It is known as the Lo-S
Below is another magic square, this time of order four. Note that its elements are from the finite arithmetic
sequence 7, 10, 13, 16, , 52, and the magic number is 118.
52 13 10 43
19 34 37 28
31 22 25 40
16 49 46
245
Algebra 9
What kind of relation exists between the sequence and the magic number? Given any finite arithmetic sequence
of n2 terms is it always possible to construct a magic square? If the numbers do not form an arithmetic sequence,
is it possible to construct a magic square?
Try constructing your own magic square of order three using the numbers 4,8,12, ,36.
There are many unsolved puzzles concerning magic squares. The puzzle of Yang-Hui, which was solved in the
year 2000, was one of them. According to the legend the 13th century Chinese mathematician Yang-Hui gave
the emperor Sung his last magic square as a gift. This is Yang-Huis square:
The special property of Yang-Hui's square was that the square had elements of a finite arithmetic sequence with
common difference 210 such that when 1 was added to each cell it would become another magic square with all
elements prime numbers. But the emperor wanted the magic square to also give prime numbers when 1 was
subtracted from each cell. He promised some land along the river to the mathematician if it was completed.
Unfortunately, the life of Yang-Hui wasnt long enough to solve this puzzle. Below is the solution to the problem,
calculated 725 years later:
246
A. GEOMETRIC SEQUENCES
1. Definition
In the previous section, we learned about
arithmetic sequences, i.e. sequences whose
consecutive terms have a common difference.
In this chapter we will look at another type of
sequence, called a geometric sequence.
Geometric sequences play an important role in
mathematics.
A sequence is called geometric if the ratio between each consecutive term is common. For
example, look at the sequence 3, 6, 12, 24, 48,
Obviously the ratio of each term to the previous term is equal to 2, so we can formulize the
sequence as bn+1 = bn 2. The consecutive terms of the sequence have a common ratio (2),
so this sequence is geometric.
1
For the sequence 625, 125, 25, 5, 1, the formula will be bn+1 = bn . The common ratio
5
1
in this sequence is .
5
geometric sequence
Definition
If a sequence (bn) has the same ratio q between its consecutive terms, then it is called a
geometric sequence.
In other words, (bn) is geometric if bn+1 = bn q such that n , q . q is called the
common ratio of the sequence. In this book, from now on we will use bn to denote the
general term of a geometric sequence, and q to denote the common ratio.
If q > 1, the geometric sequence is increasing when b1 > 0 and decreasing when b1 < 0.
If 0 < q < 1, geometric sequence is increasing when b1 < 0 and decreasing when b1 > 0.
If q < 0, then the sequence is not monotone.
What can you say if q = 1? What about q = 0?
EXAMPLE
53
Solution
Sequences and Series
State whether the following sequences are geometric or not. If a sequence is geometric, find
the common ratio.
1
1
a. 1, 2, 4, 8,
b. 3, 3, 3, 3,
c. 1, 4, 9, 16,
d. 5, 1, ,
, ...
5 25
a. geometric, q = 2
b. geometric, q = 1
c. not geometric
d. geometric,
q=
247
1
5
EXAMPLE
54
State whether the sequences with the given general terms are geometric or not. If a sequence
is geometric, find the common ratio.
a. bn = 3n
Solution
b. bn = n2 + 3
c. bn = 3 2n+3
d. bn = 3n + 5
bn+1 3n+1
= n = 3, which is
bn
3
bn+1 3 2 n+4
=
= 2, which is
bn
3 2 n+3
d. Since the general term has a linear form, this is an arithmetic sequence. It is not geometric.
With the help of the above example we can see that if the formula for the general term of a
sequence gives us an exponential function with a linear exponent (a function with only one
exponent variable), then it is geometric.
Note
The general term of a geometric sequence is exponential.
2. General Term
We have seen that for a geometric sequence, bn+1 = bn q. This formula is defined recursively.
If we want to make faster calculations, we need to express the general term of a geometric
sequence more directly. The formula is derived as follows:
If (bn) is geometric, then we only know that bn+1 = bn q. Let us write a few terms.
b1 b1
b2 = b1 q
b3 = b2 q =( b1 q ) q = b1 q 2
b4 = b3 q =( b1 q 2 ) q = b1 q 3
b5 = b1 q 4
bn = b1 q n1
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
55
Solution
If 100, 50, 25 are the first three terms of a geometric sequence (bn), find the sixth term.
We can calculate the common ratio as q =
b3 b2 1
1
= = , so b1 =100, q = .
2
b2
b1 2
1 6 1 25
n 1
Using the general term formula, bn = b1 q , so b6 =100 ( ) = .
2
8
EXAMPLE
56
Solution
1
(bn) is a geometric sequence with b1 = , q = 3. Find b4.
3
EXAMPLE
57
Solution
1
(bn) is a geometric sequence with b1 = 15, q = . Find the
5
general term.
EXAMPLE
58
1 4 1
3 = 9.
3
n 1
1
.
5
Solution
1 1
= 15 = 75
5 5
1
and q = 3. Is 243 a term of this
9
1 n 1
3 .
9
1 3n
, and so 3 n = 3 8. Therefore, n= 8.
9 3
Since 8 is a natural number, 243 is the eighth term of this sequence.
Now 243 =
249
EXAMPLE
59
Solution
b2
= 3. Find b2.
b4
1
3
b12
Check Yourself 9
1. Is the sequence with general term bn =
2.
1 n+3
a geometric sequence? Why?
4
3
3 3 3
are the first three terms of a geometric sequence (bn). Find the eighth term.
, ,
16 8 4
1
3. (bn) is a non-monotone geometric sequence with b1 = , b7 =16. Find the common ratio
4
of the sequence and b4.
2. 24
3. q = 2; b4 = 2
4. no
60
Solution
1
(bn) is a geometric sequence with b4 = 56, q = . Find b9.
2
1
b4 = b1 q3 , that is 56 = b1 ( ) 3. So b1 = 448.
2
1
7
b9 = b1 q8 = 448 ( ) 8 =
2
4
In this example, we calculated the first term of the sequence (b1) from b4, then used this
value to find b9. However, there is a quicker way to solve this problem: in general, if we know
the common ratio and any term of a geometric sequence, we can find the required term
without finding the first term. Look at the calculation:
250
Algebra 9
(1)
bp = b 1 q
(2)
p1
bn
= qn p .
bp
Here, it is not important which term you write in the place of bn and bp.
Note that when p = 1, the advanced general term formula becomes the general term formula
we studied previously.
EXAMPLE
61
Solution
1
, b8 = 4 4. Find the common ratio.
32
1
4
8
= 2 5 and b8 = 4 =2 .
32
Using the advanced general term formula,
We have b5 =
bn = bp qn p
b8 = b5 q3
28 = 25 q3, so q = 3
2 8
1
= .
2 5
2
If p r is odd, q = p r
bp
br
bp
br
bp
br
= qp r .
251
bp
, if p r is even
p r
br
q=
bp
, if p r is odd
p r
br
EXAMPLE
62
Solution
where p > r.
Given a monotone geometric sequence (bn) with b3 = 9, b5 = 16, find the common ratio.
Using the common ratio formula,
q = 5 3
b5
4
4
= . Since the sequence is monotone, q = . Otherwise, one term would be
3
3
b3
negative and the next would be positive, and that would give a sequence which is neither
increasing nor decreasing. Note that if we did not know that the sequence was monotone,
then there would be two possible answers.
EXAMPLE
63
Solution
8
32
(bn) is a non-monotone geometric sequence with b2 = 2, b4 = . Which term is
?
9
81
Since the sequence is not monotone, the common ratio is negative. Using the common ratio
formula, q = 4 2
b4
b
2
32
is a term, then
= 4 = . If
81
3
b2
b2
bp = b2 q p 2 , that is
32
2
2
2
= 2 ( ) p 2, so ( ) 4 = ( ) p 2, which means p = 6.
81
3
3
3
32
is the sixth term.
81
64
Solution
252
Let us apply the advanced general term formula, keeping in mind that we just know b8:
b2 = b8 q2 8
b14 = b8 q
14 8
(1)
.
(2)
(1)
bp + k = bp q .
(2)
sequence is equal to the product of any two terms that are at equal distance from x in the
sequence. In the previous example note that b8 was at equal distance from of b2 and b14.
(Could we solve the problem if we were given b8 instead of b10?)
MIDDLE TERM FORMULA (Geometric Mean)
In a geometric sequence bp2 = bp k bp + k where k < p.
For example, all the following equalities will hold in a geometric sequence.
The geometric mean of
two numbers x and y is
m if m = xy.
Note that m is the same
distance from x as from
y, so x, m, y form a finite
geometric sequence.
EXAMPLE
65
Solution
(x must be 12)
(y must be 15)
Note
Three numbers a, b, c form consecutive terms of a geometric sequence if and only if
b2 = a c.
Sequences and Series
253
EXAMPLE
66
Solution
Find the common ratio q for the geometric sequence (bn) with b1 = 32 and b2 b9 = 2.
2
, which is nonsense!
Using the middle term formula, we get b2 b9 = b5.5
2
.
Realizing that we are given b1, lets write another nonsense equation: b1 b10 = b5.5
We know that there is no b5.5 but we have b2 b9 and b1 b10 which are equal. That is,
b1 b10 = b2 b9 , so 32 b10 = 2. Therefore, b10 =
1
.
16
1
1
= 32 q9. Therefore, q= .
16
2
Check Yourself 10
1
1. (bn) is a geometric sequence with b4 =12 and q = . Find b7.
3
2. (bn) is a geometric sequence with b7 = 9 and b10 = 72. Find the common ratio.
5
and b8 =10. Find b10.
4
4. Fill in the blanks if the following numbers form a geometric sequence: 2, __, __, __, 162.
Answers
1. 4
2. 2
9
EXAMPLE
67
Solution
3. 40
4. 6, 18, 54 or 6, 18, 54
Given a monotone geometric sequence (bn) with b1 + b5 = 30, b3 + b7 = 120, find b1.
We must express these two equations in terms of two variables, say b1 and q.
b1 + b5 = 30
, so
b3 + b7 = 120
b1 + b1 q4 = 30
, so
b1 q2 + b1 q6 = 120
b1 (1 + q4) = 30
b1 q2 (1 + q4) = 120
(1)
(2)
30
.
17
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
68
Solution
Three numbers form a geometric sequence. If we increase the second number by 2, we get
an arithmetic sequence. After this, if we increase the third number by 9, we get a geometric
sequence again. Find the three initial numbers.
Since we are given three numbers, let us solve this problem with the help of the middle term
formulas for arithmetic and geometric sequences. Naming these numbers a, b, and c
respectively, we have:
a, b, c
geometric sequence
a, b + 2, c
arithmetic sequence
a, b + 2, c + 9
geometric sequence
a+ c
, that is
b + 2 =
2
2
( b + 2) = a( c +9)
Using (3) i n (1) , b2 =
2
b = ac
2 b+ 4 = a+ c
b2 + 4b + 4 = ac
+9a
b2
4b + 4
9b 2
c , so c =
.
9
4b + 4
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
4b + 4
9b 2
+
, so 25b2 184b 128 = 0.
9
4b + 4
16
or b = 8. Substituting these numbers in (3)
25
a = 25
a = 4
16
So the system will have b =
or b = 8 as possible solution sets.
25
c =16
64
c =
25
255
EXAMPLE
69
Solution
Find four numbers forming a geometric sequence such that the second term is 35 less than
the first term and the third term is 560 more than the fourth term.
For convenience, let us denote the terms by a, b, c, d, and the common ratio as usual by q.
Our data now looks like the following:
b = a 35
c = d +560.
We have to reduce the number of variables to two using the fact that we have a geometric
sequence.
aq = a 35
, so
2
aq = aq3 +560
35
a = 1 q
35
35
2
3
1 q q = 1 q q +560
(1)
(2)
35
140
560
2240
, b=
, c=
, d=
.
3
3
3
3
Both of these sets of values are possible solution sets for the problem.
EXAMPLE
70
Solution
256
Given the geometric sequence with general term bn = 3 (2)n, find the sum of first three
terms.
S3 = b1 + b2 + b3 = 6 + 12 24 = 18
Algebra 9
How could we find S100 in the previous example? Calculating terms and finding their sums
takes time and effort for large sums. As geometric sequences grow very fast, we need a more
efficient way of calculating these sums. The following theorem meets our needs:
Theorem
1 qn
, q 1.
1 q
Sn = b1 + b2 + b3 +...+ bn 1 + bn
Sn = b1 + b1 q + b1 q 2 +...+ b1 q n 2 + b1 q n 1
(1)
q Sn = b1 q + b1 q2 + b1 q 3 +...+ b1 qn 1 + b1 q n
(2)
EXAMPLE
71
Solution
72
Solution
73
Solution
1 qn
1 1 36 364
, so S6 =
=
.
1 q
81 1 3
81
EXAMPLE
1
and q = 3, find S6.
81
EXAMPLE
1 qn
1 q
1 q6
1 36
, so 3640 = b1
, and so b1 =10.
1 q
1 3
1
Given a geometric sequence with q = , bp = 5 and Sp =1820, find b1.
3
257
EXAMPLE
74
Solution
x3 y3 =(xy)(x2 +xy+y2)
x3+y3=(x+y)(x2xy+y2)
19
, find q.
3
1 q3
19
(1 q)(1+ q+ q 2 )
19
, and so
=3
. Therefore,
=1+ q+ q2.
1 q
3
1 q
9
5
2
or q = .
3
3
Check Yourself 11
1. Given a geometric sequence with b1 = 1 and q = 2, find S7.
2. Given a geometric sequence with S9 = 513 and q = 2, find b5.
3. Given a geometric sequence with q = 2, b1 = 7, and Sp = 896, find p.
4. Given a geometric sequence with b1 = 192 and S3 = 252, find q.
Answers
1. 43
EXAMPLE
75
Solution
2. 48
3. 8
4. 5 or 1
4
4
45
45
, b6 b4 =
, find b1 and q.
32
512
3
b1 q b1 q = 32
, so
45
5
3
b1 q b1 q = 512
45
2
b1 q (q 1) = 32
45
3
2
b1 q ( q 1) = 512
(1)
(2)
1
1
, so q = .
16
4
1
Since the sequence is monotone, we take q = .
4
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
76
Solution
Given a geometric sequence with S7 = 14 and S14 = 18, find b15 + ... + b21.
Clearly, b15 + ... + b21 = S21 S14.
However, we are given S7 and S14, so we need to find a way of expressing S21 in terms of the
given data.
S21 = b1
1 q21
(1 q7 )(1+ q7 + q14 )
= b1
1 q
1 q
(1)
S14 = b1
1 q14
(1 q7 )(1+ q7 )
= b1
1 q
1 q
(2)
1 q7
1 q
(3)
S7 = b1
(4)
(5)
S14
18
2
1=
1= .
14
7
S7
EXAMPLE
77
Solution
(bn) is a geometric sequence such that the sum of the first three terms is 91, and the terms
b1 + 25, b2 + 27, b3 + 1 form an arithmetic sequence. Find b1.
Using the sum formula,
S3 = b1
1 q3
(1 q)(1+ q+ q2 )
= b1
, so b1 (1+ q + q 2 ) = 91.
1 q
(1 q)
(1)
b1 + 25+ b3 +1
,
2
so b1 q + 27 =
since b2 is
a term of a
geometric sequence
b1 + 25+ b1 q 2 +1
.
2
(2)
259
1
or q = 3.
3
1
If q = , then using equation (1) or (2) we get b1 = 63.
3
If q = 3, then using equation (1) or (2) we get b1 = 7.
2. Applied Problems
EXAMPLE
78
Solution
q = 0.9
(the ratio of distance covered to the distance covered in the preceding second)
S5 = ?
1 q5
1 0.9 5
= 20
= 81.902.
1 q
1 0.9
Therefore, before the brakes are applied the car moves 81.902 m.
EXAMPLE
79
Solution
260
How many ancestors from parents through great-great-great grandparents do three unrelated
people have?
Lets try to formulize the problem. Each person has two parents, a mother and a father, and
these people are distinct because the people in the problem are unrelated. These parents are
the closest generation to the original people; we can call them the first generation. Now, each
person in the first generation also has two different parents, which we can call the second
generation. If we continue like this, we can see that there are five generations, and each
generation contains twice the number of people of the previous generation. This is a
geometric sequence, and we can write,
b1 = 6
q=2
S5 = ?
1 25
=186.
1 2
So the three unrelated people will have 186 ancestors from parents through great-great-great
grandparents.
EXAMPLE
80
Solution
A set of five weights has a total mass of 930 g. If the weights are arranged in order from the
lightest to the heaviest, the second weight has twice the mass of the first, and so on. What is
the mass of the heaviest weight?
Let us formulize the problem:
S5 = 930, q = 2, b5 = ?.
Using the sum formula,
S5 = b1
1 q5
1 25
, then 930 = b1
, so b1 = 30.
1 q
1 2
EXAMPLE
81
2
of its previous
3
height. What is the total distance the ball has traveled in the air when it hits the ground for the
fifth time?
Solution
2
Choosing b1 = 81, q = , S5 = ? wont give us the answer
3
that is required. To understand why, let us look at the
2
as the first term, we can formulize our answer
3
as,
4
2
2
3
81
Total distance =
81 +
2
2
3
first fall
rise
and
fall
3
b1 in the figure
= 341 cm.
261
Check Yourself 12
1. Given a monotone geometric sequence with b4 b2 =
and q.
45
45
and b6 b4 =
, find b1
32
512
3
as many leaves in each
2
successive week. At the end of seven weeks all the leaves have fallen. How many leaves
2. A tree loses 384 leaves during the first week of fall and
2. 12 354 leaves
1
1
1
1
, ( bn ) = (3,
,
,
, ...).
30
10 300
9000
In both examples, the terms get closer to zero as n increases. In the second example the
approach is more rapid than in the first, and the sequence alternates between positive and
negative numbers.
A simple investigation with a few more examples will quickly reveal that for geometric
sequences with common ratio 1 < q < 1, as n increases the total sum of the terms (Sn)
eventually settles down to a constant value. In other words, we can find the infinite sum of
a geometric sequence with common ratio 1 < q < 1.
EXAMPLE
82
Solution
262
1 1 1
Find 1+ + + +...
2 4 8
1
Clearly each term of this sum is a term of the geometric sequence with b1 =1 and q = .
2
We are looking for the infinite sum, i.e. S.
Algebra 9
1
1
1 q
2 =1 1 0 = 2.
=1
S = b1
1
1
1 q
1
2
2
1 1
1
Here, ( ) = = = 0, since 1 has no significance next to 2.
2
2
2
We now have an equation which helps us to calculate the infinite sum of a geometric
sequence.
Theorem
The infinite sum of a geometric sequence (bn) with common ratio |q| 1 is denoted by S,
and is given by the formula S =
b1
.
1 q
since q 1
Proof
1 0
1 q
by the general sum formula. If we choose n , S = b1
Sn = b1
1 q
1 q
n
b1
.
1 q
Note
Remember that the total sum of terms only settles at a constant value if 1 < q < 1.
If |q| 1, then the geometric sequence has no infinite sum.
EXAMPLE
83
Solution
EXAMPLE
84
Solution
Find 5 + 10 20 + ...
Here, q = 2. Therefore, there is no infinite sum. (2 < 1).
2. Repeating Decimals
When we use a calculator, at the end of division we often have rational numbers with
repeating decimals, i.e. decimals with a repeating sequence of one or more digits in the
fraction part. We can use our knowledge of the infinite sum of a geometric sequence to write
repeating decimals as fractions.
Sequences and Series
263
Note
We can write a repeating decimal such as 0.66666... as 0.6 or 0.(6). In this book, we use the
first notation.
EXAMPLE
85
Solution
0.72 = 0.727272...
= 0.72 + 0.0072 + 0.000072 + ...
= 0.72 + 0.72 0.01 + 0.72 0.0001 + ...
= 0.72 + 0.72 0.01 + 0.72 (0.01)2 + ...
Now we can see that each term of this sum is a term of the geometric sequence with
b1 = 0.72, q = 0.01 and we are looking for the infinite sum, that is S.
Using the infinite sum formula,
S=
EXAMPLE
86
Solution
0.72
72
8
=
= .
1 0.01 99 11
2.15 = 2.1555...
= 2.1 + 0.05 + 0.005 + 0.0005 + ...
nonrepeating
part
0.05
21 5
97
7
= +
=
=2 .
1 0.1 10 90 45
45
87
Solution
264
4
Solve 2+ 2 x + 2 x2 +... = .
x
In this problem our traditional methods of solving equations will not help since we cannot
see completely which equation we have. Let us try to see an infinite sum of a geometric
sequence in this equation.
Algebra 9
4
2 + 2 x + 2 x2 +... =
x
b1
b2
b3
Here, we should note that this equation will have a solution if and only if |q| 1, that is
|x| 1. If |x| > 1, there is no infinite sum.
Now, using the infinite sum formula,
S=
b1
4
2
2
, that is =
, so x = .
x 1 x
1 q
3
Since
EXAMPLE
88
Solution
2
2
<1, the only solution of this non-standard equation is x = .
3
3
13
.
6
Now we have:
S
13
2
3
2 x +1+ x + ( x ) + x4 + ( x5 ) +... =
6
b1
b2
b3
( q= x ,
x <1)
b4
Note that since there is no way to express 2x + 1 in the infinite sum, we exclude it from the
geometric sequence.
Now, using the infinite sum formula,
2 x +1+
x2
13
= , which means 18 x2 +5 x 7 = 0.
1 ( x)
6
7
1
or x = , both of which satisfy the condition
9
2
7
1
or x = .
9
2
Check Yourself 13
1. Can we find
1 3 9
+ + +... ? Why?
2 4 8
2. Find
9
9
9
2 + 3 ... .
10 10
10
3
4. Solve x + x3 + x5 +... = .
8
265
Answers
1. no, because q > 1 2. 9
11
3.
1
15
4.
1
3
4. Applied Problems
EXAMPLE
89
Solution
1
of its
3
50
1
3 =100 cm.
1
1
3
50
EXAMPLE
90
Solution
Consider an equilateral triangle made from paper. We take our scissors and cut off smaller
equilateral triangles from the original triangle using the following principle: connect the
middle points of the sides of every triangle you see. Cut out and throw away the middle
triangle you make. Repeat the process with every new triangle you see. How much of the
original area will remain if we dont stop cutting?
Let us look at a diagram of the problem, where x shows the area of the triangle we throw away
each time:
x
x
...
x
x
After cutting the first triangle, we throw away one new triangle. After cutting the second
triangle we throw away three new triangles, and so on.
266
Algebra 9
Now let a be the sidelength of our equilateral triangle. If we say S is the area of the triangle
at the beginning, and S is the sum of the subtracted areas we have,
S=
a2 3
(formula for area of an equilateral triangle with sidelength a)
4
sidelength of
the triangle
that we cut
S =
we cut out
one triangle
in the first phase
a 2
( )
2
4
a 2
a 2
a2 3
)
3
(
)
3
2
3
a2 3
+3 2
+9 2
+... = 16 =
.
3
4
4
4
1
4
(
(42)
(43)
(44)
(45)
267
3 .3
EXERCISES
A. Geometric Sequences
geometric or not.
25
, ...)
2
c. (bn) = (2n + 7)
a. (2, 5,
b. (bn)= (4n
terms.
sequence are
a. b1 = 5, q = 2
c. b1 =1000, q =
1
10
e. b1 = 4, b4 = 32
g. b3 = 32, b6 =
1
2
n +1
and
n 1
25 n 75+50 n
d. b1 = 3, q = 3
1
27
h. b5 = 5, b25 = 5
f. b1 = 3, b5 =
b4 1
=
and b2 + b5 = 216, find b1.
b6 4
i. b1 = 2, b6 = 82
n +3
b. b2 = 6, b7 = 192, S11 = ?
c. b2 = 1, b5 b2 = 64 b4 b5, S5 = ?
d. S3 = 111, q3 = 4, S6 = ?
n 1
n digits
2n digits
5
3
b. b1 = , S = , q = ?
2
2
c. S = 5b1, q = ?
n digits
a. 54 + 18 + 6 + ...
b.
3
2
1+ ...
2
3
9
c. 7+ 3+ +...
7
d.
1 1 1
+ ...
12 6 3
24. Find
b. 5.142
c. 3.202
d. 2.065
1 1 1 1 1 1
+ +
+...
2 3 4 9 8 27
4
of the length of the preceding one.
5
Find the total distance that the bob travels before
swing is
it stops.
108
. Find b1 and q.
13
2
x
4
and told the students that these are the first two
terms of a sequence. He asked the students to find
the third term. Since he didnt mention the type of
the sequence, some students thought the sequence
was arithmetic while some thought it was geometric.
Find the positive difference between the two
possible answers to the teachers problem.
x2
+...<1.
16
x +1 x +1
x
+
+... = .
x
1
x
1
2
30. Solve 1+
Mixed Problems
sequence. (y + 1) , xy + 1, (x 1) form a
geometric sequence. Find x and y.
34. The first, the third, and the fifth term of a geometric
sequence are equal to the first, the fourth, and
the sixteenth term of a certain arithmetic
sequence respectively. Find the fourth term of the
arithmetic sequence if its first term is 5.
270
42. If
1
1
1
form an arithmetic sequence,
,
,
b a 2b b c
43. Find
11...11
22...22
.
16 digits
8 digits
Algebra 9
A Koch snowflake is another mathematical construction. We make a Koch snowflake by making progressive
additions to an equilateral triangle. We divide the triangles sides into thirds, and then create a new triangle on
each middle third. Then we repeat the process over and over. Thus, each snowflake shows more complexity, but
every new triangle in the design looks exactly like the initial one.
Now imagine drawing a circle around the original figure. Notice that no matter how large the perimeter gets, the
area of the figure remains inside the circle. In the Koch Snowflake, an infinite perimeter encloses a finite area.
Although it sounds impossible, we can prove it as follows:
Calculating the perimeter of the Koch Snowflake:
To simplify the problem, let us describe what happens to one side of the triangle as the procedure is repeated.
Suppose that the original length of one side is L. Then we go through the following steps:
Step 1:
Step 2:
Step 3:
1 L
four times four segments, each of length . The total length of the side is now
3 3
L
4
. The total length of the side is now L.
3
3
4 4
4
L = L.
3 3
3
Step n:
4
Total length =
3
n 1
L.
At each stage of the process, the length of one of the original sides of the triangle increases by a factor of
4
. Considering that we measure this length three times for each snowflake (as each snowflake has three sides),
3
4
this leads to a geometric sequence of the form 3L
3
the perimeter of the Koch snowflake is infinite.
Sequences and Series
n 1
271
3
1 1
Step 3: Total area is A(1+ + 3 4 )
9
9 9
3
A
3
1
1
1
Step n: Total area is A(1+ + 3 4 ( )2 + 3 42 ( )3 +...+ 3 4n 2 ( )n 1 )
9
9
9
9
3
4
each term in this sum is
times the previous one. Therefore we can calculate the sum of all the
9
9
3
8A
areas added using the formula for the sum of an infinite geometric sequence: Area = A 1+ 9 =
.
4
5
This is the area of the entire snowflake, which means that even if we repeat this procedure without end, the total
8A
area will never be more than
.
5
If we combine our calculations of the perimeter and area of the snowflake, we have proved that an infinite
perimeter borders a finite area.
Below is another kind of snowflake. What can you say about its area and perimeter?
3A
I.
n
n2
II. 3
III. n2 + 2n + 3
IV.
7 n
V. 3n
VI. nn
A) 0
A) I, II, III, IV
C) I, II, III, VI
D) II, III, V, VI
1
2 n +1
) are less than ?
3
n +9
B) 1
E) III, IV, V, VI
6. Given an = (
C) 2
B) 5
D)
E) 4
3n2 5n
) and a5 = 3, find k.
n+ k 3
A) 3
D) 3
35
3
22
3
C)
E)
44
3
B) 2n
C) 2n + 1
E) n2 + 2
D) n + 1
2an +5
for n 1,
2
B) 25
D)
27
2
C) 22
E)
25
2
term
A) 5
n2 2 n + 36
are natural numbers?
n
B) 6
C) 7
D) 8
V. ( en ) = (
IV. ( dn ) = (
1
)
n +1
(1)n
)
3n + 2
B) 2
C) 3
D) 4
E) 5
E) 9
A) 1
3n 5
)
n+ 2
A) 1
B) 3
2n + 3
)?
3n 7
C) 2
D) 7
E) 8
273
A) n + 2n
B) 4n + 5
D) 2n + 3
C) n
A) 49
B) 47
C) 45
D) 44
E) 43
E) 5n
A)
7
24
B)
23
24
C)
21
16
D)
23
16
E)
69
49
B) 6
C) 16
D) 22
E) 28
1
. Find the general term.
3
A) 3n + 4
B)
D)
274
n+ 4
3
n +7
3
E)
C)
n + 20
3
n4
3
1
1
, last term
, and sum 9. How many terms
16
2
are there in this sequence?
A) 9
B) 16
C) 32
D) 48
E) 64
B) 11
C) 10
D) 9
E) 8
2
51
B)
D)
13
51
13
51
C)
E)
2
51
15
51
Algebra 9
A
3B
B) 330
C) 360
D) 630
E) 660
E)
1
2
1
7
A)
B) 3
C) 4
D) 5
1
. Find the seventh term.
32
1
8
B)
1
16
2 n
2
7
C)
1
4
D)
1
. Find the general term.
2
B)
D)
1
8
1 n
2
14
7
2 2n
C)
E)
2
7 2n
14
2n
B) 1
C) 2
D) 3
E) 4
1
and b6 b8 = . Which one of the following can
3
be the common ratio?
A)
4.
3
1
form an arithmetic sequence.
, a, b, c,
7
35
Find
A)
2
3
ab
.
c
B)
16
9
1
2
B)
2
3
C) 1
3
2
D)
E) 2
1
16
to form a monotone geometric sequence. Find
C)
2
3
D)
3
4
E)
1
2
A) 4
B) 2
C)
1
2
D)
1
4
E)
275
1
8
9.
625 125 25
,
,
are the first three terms of a
32 16
8
geometric sequence. Find the eighth term.
A)
125
8
B)
25
16
C)
16
25
D)
8
625
E)
4
125
1
1
1
1
1
m B)
m C)
m D)
m E)
m
27
243
9
81
486
B) 24(2 2)
E) 24(2 2)
D) 24(2 + 1)
3 2
B)
2
C) 3
D) 32
E) 62
16
cm 2
3
D)
16. Find
B) 2
C) 4
D) 8
E) 16
C) 24(2 1)
A) 1
B)
32
cm 2
3
64
cm 2
3
C) 32 cm2
E) 64 cm2
1 1 1 1 1 1
+ +
+...
3 2 9 4 27 8
B)
1
2
C) 0
D)
1
2
E) 1
Algebra 9
x3
y y3 x
B) x2
D)
A
3C
x3 x4 x5
+ + +...
y4 y5 y6
x3
y y3 x
x 2 + x3
y4 y3 x
C) 0
E) x2 +
B) 57
C) 75
D) 93
E) 107
x3
y4 y3 x
B) 12
C) 10
D) 8
A) 2 + 5
D)
B)
5 +1
2
10 10 5
C)
10 5 10
5+ 5
E) 2 5
5 5
E) 4
0.13 ?
A)
2
15
B)
13
90
C)
1
75
D)
11
90
E)
2 n 13
term an =
are negative?
3n +7
B) 8
C) 7
D) 6
A) 106
B) 107
C) 108
D) 1010
E) 1012
13
99
A) 9
E) 5
B) 679
C) 582
D) 579
E) 485
277
B) 4n + 5
D) 4n 13
C) 5n 4
E) 5n + 13
B) 42
C) 48
D) 49
E) 54
B) 1
C) 0
D) 2
E) 4
B) 2
C) 1
D) 2
E) 4
A) 2 a
3
2
B) 2
3
8
D) 2 a
5
2
8
3
5
3
C) 2
E) 2
8
3
4
3
5
2
5
2
C) 3 1
B) 3 1
D) 2 3
E) 3 2
B) a2 a
C) a2 1
E) a 1
B) 192
C) 186
D) 182
E) 176
Algebra 9
279
Objectives
clock arithmetic
Arithmetic with time is called clock arithmetic.
A traditional clock face has twelve numbers. It shows clock arithmetic in the twelve-hour clock
system. In this system, four hours after nine oclock is one oclock.
a.m.(ante meridien) = in
the morning
p.m.(post meridien) = in
the afternoon / evening
These abbreviations come
from Latin. Meridien
means midday, ante
means before and post
means after.
Some digital clock use twenty-four numbers, from 0 to 23. This is the twenty-four-hour clock
system. In this system, four hours after 9:00 is 13:00.
When we talk about time with the twelve-hour clock, we use the abbreviation a.m. (ante meridien)
to express the time before midday and p.m. (post meridien) to express the time after midday.
For example, when we say the time is 8 a.m., we mean that it is eight oclock in the morning.
If we say the time is 8 p.m., we mean that it is eight oclock in the evening. 8 p.m. means that
it is 20:00.
Note that we do not usually say twenty-one oclock or nineteen oclock, etc. in English.
Instead, we say eleven oclock at night (or eleven p.m.) and seven oclock in the evening (or
seven p.m.), etc. In some formal situations (for example, in a railway station announcement,
or talking to a pilot on a plane), people say twenty-one hundred hours or nineteen hundred
hours, etc.
280
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
Solution
Check Yourself 1
1. Write each time in the twelve-hour system.
a. five oclock in the morning
b. 19:00
c. 21:00
d. 13:00
e. 12:00
f. 00:00
b. 8 a.m.
c. 10 p.m.
d. 11 p.m.
e. 5 a.m.
Answers
1. a. 5 a.m. b. 10 a.m. c. 6 p.m. d. 12 p.m. 2. a. 5 a.m. b. 7 p.m. c. 9 p.m. d. 1 p.m.
e. 12 a.m. f. 12 p.m. 3. a. 15:00 b. 8:00 c. 22:00 d. 23:00 e. 5:00
281
Definition
modulo notation
Let a, b, Z, m Z+ (m > 1) such that
a = m b + k (0 k < m).
Then we can write
a k (mod m)
and say a is equivalent (or congruent) to k, modulo m. Often we abbreviate modulo to mod.
a
m
bm b
______
k
a=mb+k
For example,
13 1 (mod 12) (thirteen is congruent to 1 mod 12) because 13 = 121 + 1
or a k (mod m)
23 = 12 1 + 11
12 0 (mod 12)
because
12 = 12 1 + 0
32 8 (mod 12)
because
32 = 12 2 + 8.
The same principles apply when we are working with other modula.
EXAMPLE
Solution
b. 14 x (mod 6)
c. 22 x (mod 7)
d. 29 x (mod 8)
a. 12 2 (mod 5) because 12 = 5 2 + 2
b. 14 2 (mod 6) because 14 = 6 2 + 2
c. 22 1 (mod 7) because 22 = 7 3 + 1
d. 29 5 (mod 8) because 29 = 8 3 + 5
3. Clock Addition
We now know how to write a number in modular notation. How can we write a sum? For this
purpase we define a new addition operation which is called clock addition or modular addition. It is shown by .
For example, 10 4 2 (mod 12). We say this as ten plus 4 is congruent to 2 modulo 12.
Look at some more examples of modular addition:
11 7 6 (mod 12)
8 5 1 (mod 12)
9 3 0 (mod 12).
We can show all the possible results of addition for a certain modulus in a table and then find
results easily by using it.
282
Algebra 9
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
10
11
11
11
10
Solution
b. 3 2
c. 6 7
d. 6 10
e. 11 1
f. 10 0
a. 8 11 7 (mod 12)
b. 3 2 5 (mod 12)
c. 6 7 1 (mod 12)
d. 6 10 4 (mod 12)
e. 11 1 0 (mod 12)
f. 10 0 10 (mod 12)
We have seen clock addition for modulo 12. Now think of a clock which has only six hours. The
clock would look like the one on the left. The set of numerals for the six-hour clock system is {0,
1, 2, 3, 4, 5}.
For example, in the six-hour clock system, five hours after two oclock is one oclock:
2 5 1 (mod 6).
We can make an addition table for six-hour clock arithmetic.
Check these results in the table:
2 5 1 (mod 6)
3 5 2 (mod 6)
4 3 1 (mod 6)
4 4 2 (mod 6)
0 0 0 (mod 6)
3 2 5 (mod 6).
Modular Arithmetic
283
Check Yourself 2
1. Find the number x.
a. 15 x (mod 12)
b. 18 x (mod 12)
c. 12 x (mod 12)
d. 28 x (mod 12)
e. 24 x (mod 12)
f. 7 x (mod 12)
a. 13 x (mod 5)
b. 17 x (mod 5)
c. 12 x (mod 6)
d. 23 x (mod 6)
e. 15 x (mod 7)
f. 29 x (mod 7)
g. 6 x (mod 4)
h. 11 x (mod 8)
i. 17 x (mod 3)
Answers
1. a. 3 b. 6 c. 0 d. 4 e. 0 f. 7 2. a. 3 b. 2 c. 0 d. 5 e. 1 f. 1 g. 2 h. 3 i. 2
20 7
14 2
____
remainder 6.
EXAMPLE
Solution
b. 16 8 x (mod 5)
c. 12 5 x (mod 9)
d. 42 23 x (mod 12)
a. 7 11 18 2 (mod 8):
18 8
16 2
____
2 remainder
x=2
284
b. 16 8 24 4 (mod 5):
24 5
20 4
____
4 remainder
x=4
Algebra 9
c. 12 5 17 8 (mod 9):
d. 42 23 65 5 (mod 12):
17 9
9 1
____
8 remainder
65 12
60 5
____
5 remainder
x=8
x=5
We can add more than two numbers with respect to a given modulus in the same way.
For example, 10 5 18 33 1 (mod 8), and
20 8 12 15 55 6 (mod 7).
Sometimes it is easier to break up the sum into smaller sums:
20 8 12 15 ? (mod 7)
0
(mod 7)
6 (mod 7).
(mod 7)
If we are adding large numbers, sometimes it is easier to write each addend in modular
notation, and then add the results.
Rule
2 3 5 (mod 7).
Alternatively, we can write 128 + 241 = 369 and then calculate 369 5 (mod 7).
EXAMPLE
Solution
Modular Arithmetic
285
EXAMPLE
Solution
a. 3 4
b. 4 3
c. (4 3) 5
d. 4 (3 5)
e. 3 3
f. 1 5
a. 3 4 1 (mod 6)
b. 4 3 1 (mod 6)
c. (4 3) 5 1 5 0 (mod 6)
d. 4 (3 5) 4 2 0 (mod 6)
e. 3 3 0 (mod 6)
f. 1 5 0 (mod 6)
Check Yourself 3
1. Find each sum.
a. 12 7 ? (mod 5)
b. 28 17 ? (mod 9)
c. 21 8 12 ? (mod 7)
d. 19 32 42 25 ? (mod 8)
2. Find the smallest natural number which can be used instead of x in each modular sum.
a. 15 x 0 (mod 8)
b. 35 x 6 (mod 7)
c. 21 x 8 10 (mod 11)
d. x 22 9 5 (mod 6)
e. 8 6 x 1 (mod 12)
Answers
1. a. 4 b. 0 c. 6 d. 6 2. a. 1 b. 6 c. 3 d. 4 e. 11
2. Modular Multiplication
We can multiply two numbers with respect to a given modulus by using the same method we
used for modular addition, since multiplication is a short way of adding the same numbers.
For example, 3 4 ? (mod 5),
4 + 4 + 4 = 12 2 (mod 5).
Rule
To find the product of two natural numbers with respect to a modulus m, we divide their real
product by m and write the remainder as the result.
For example,
7 6 ? (mod 10)
7 6 = 42, and 42 2 (mod 10).
So 7 6 2 (mod 10)
286
42 10
40 4
____
2 remainder
Algebra 9
Usually, if we are working with large numbers it is easier to convert each number to modulo
from first before finding the product.
Rule
Solution
45 32 3 2 0 (mod 6)
b. 15 12 ? (mod 5)
c. 8 9 14 ? (mod 10)
a. 5 4 20 2 (mod 3)
b. 15 12 180 6 0 (mod 5)
c. 8 9 14 72 14 ? (mod 10)
72 2 (mod 10)
72 14 2 4 8 (mod 10)
14 4 (mod 10)
345 3 (mod 9)
EXAMPLE
Solution
b. 7 5 ? (mod 6)
d. 11 1 ? (mod 5)
e. 17 0 ? (mod 7)
a. 5 5 (mod 6)
7 1 (mod 6)
b. 7 1 (mod 6)
5 5 (mod 6)
c. 3 5 3 7 ? (mod 8)
5 7 5 1 5 (mod 6)
7 5 1 5 5 (mod 6)
c. 3 5 3 7 15 21 36 4 (mod 8)
d. 11 1 11 1 (mod 5)
e. 17 0 0 (mod 7)
Modular Arithmetic
287
Check Yourself 4
1. Find the result of each operation.
a. 6 7 ? (mod 5)
b. 5 13 ? (mod 8)
c. 6 4 7 ? (mod 9)
e. 5 (7 8) ? (mod 6)
f. 5 7 9 8 ? (mod 6)
h. 21 3 (15 3) ? (mod 7)
Answers
1. a. 2 b. 1 c. 6 d. 8 e. 3 f. 5 g. 0 h. 4
Solution
No
If x = 1, is 2 1 3 4 (mod 5)?
No
If x = 2, is 2 2 3 4 (mod 5)?
No
If x = 3, is 2 3 3 4 (mod 5)?
Yes
If x = 4, is 2 4 3 4 (mod 5)?
No
10
Solution
288
Algebra 9
Activity
International Standard Book Numbers (ISBNs)
The ISBN system is a system for numbering books to identify them
uniquely. In the ISBN system, every book published is given a ten-digit
number which is called its ISBN number.
For example, 975-8619-69-1 is an ISBN number.
The first three digits (975) are the country code. The next four
digits (8619) identify the publisher, and 69 identifies the particular
book. The final digit (1) is a check digit. This check digit allows us
to check if the previous numbers are a valid ISBN number.
Calculating the check digit is a two-step process:
Step one: Start on the left and multipy the digits of the ISBN number
by 10, 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3 and 2 respectively. Then add these products.
(910) + (79) + (58) + (87) + (66) + (15) + (94) + (63) + (92) = 362.
Step two: Write the result in modula 11:
362 + x 0 (mod 11)
x = 1, so the check digit is 1.
Which of the following ISBN numbers have correct check numbers?
1. 975-8619-52-7
2. 1-56884-046-3
3. 1-55953-200-9
4. 0-521-62598-x (x means 10 in the ISBN system)
Check Yourself 5
1. Find x in each equation.
a. x + 3 2 (mod 5)
b. x + 5 0 (mod 9)
c. x + 1 5 (mod 8)
d. x + 7 6 (mod 9)
e. 2x 0 (mod 12)
f. 3x 4 (mod 8)
g. 6x 1 (mod 12)
h. 2x + 4 6 (mod 10)
i. 5x 1 3 (mod 6)
Check
1. a. 4 b. 4 c. 4 d. 8 e. {0, 6} f. 4 g. h. {1, 6} i. 2
Modular Arithmetic
289
b. a c (b d) (mod m)
c. a c (b d) (mod m)
d. n a (n b) (mod m)
e. an bn (mod m)
EXAMPLE
11
Solution
(n Z+)
(n Z+)
b. 17 15 x (mod 7)
d. 4 15 x (mod 7)
e. (15)4 x (mod 7)
a. 17 3 (mod 7)
15 1 (mod 7)
c. 17 15 x (mod 7)
17 + 15 3 + 1 4 (mod 7)
b. 17 15 3 1 2 (mod 7)
c. 17 15 3 1 3 (mod 7)
d. 4 15 4 1 4 (mod 7)
e. (15)4 14 1(mod 7) (any power of 1 is also 1 in any modula)
To find the remainder when a number an is divided by m, follow the steps:
1. Find x such that ax 1 (mod m).
2. Divide n by x and find the remainder.
n
x
____ t
y
a a
n
EXAMPLE
12
xt+y
= (ax)t ay 1t ay ay (mod m)
Solution
a.
b. 417 x (mod 5)
c. 725 x (mod 5)
4 1 (mod 3)
413 113 1 (mod 3)
290
Algebra 9
17 = 2 8 + 1
42 8 + 1 (42)8 41 18 41 4 (mod 5)
c. 71 2 (mod 5)
72 4 (mod 5) (72 71 71 2 2 4 (mod 5))
73 3 (mod 5) (73 72 71 4 2 3 (mod 5))
74 1 (mod 5) (74 73 71 3 2 1 (mod 5))
725 (74)6 71 16 21 1 2 2 (mod 5)
since
25
24
____
4
6
1
EXAMPLE
13
Solution
25 = 4 6 + 1.
since
EXAMPLE
14
Solution
29
28
____
1
4
7
Solve for x.
777 + 555 x (mod 8)
71 7 (mod 8)
51 5 (mod 8)
72 1 (mod 8)
52 1 (mod 8)
(52)27 51 1 5 5 (mod 8)
291
Check Yourself 6
1. Find x in each equation.
a. 635 x (mod 8)
b. 721 x (mod 9)
c. 2517 x (mod 6)
Answers
1. a. 0 b. 1 c. 1 d. 4 2. 1 3. 4 4. 7 5. 25 6. 43 7. 2 8. 2
EXAMPLE
15
Solution
292
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
16
Solution
Serdar celebrated his birthday on a Wednesday in 2002. Which day of the week was his
birthday in 2005?
2005 is three years after 2002.
In three years there are 3 365 = 1095 days, and 1095 3 (mod 7).
So Serkans birthday in 2005 will be three days after Wednesday, which is Saturday.
EXAMPLE
17
Solution
A patient takes a pill once every six hours. If he took his first pill at six oclock in the morning,
at what time will he take his twenty-sixth pill?
When the patient has taken his first pill, he will have 25 pills left. The patient takes a pill
once every six hours, so he will take his twenty-sixth pill after 150 hours (25 6 = 150 hours).
6 hours
first pill
6 hours
6 hours
second pill
...
third pill
25th pill
26th pill
We will use modulo 24 to find the time since there are 24 hours in a day.
6 150 ? (mod 24) (he took his first pill at 6 oclock)
156 12 (mod 24)
Thus, the patient will take his twenty-sixth pill at 12 oclock midday.
Check Yourself 7
1. If today is Monday, which day of the week will it be in 76 days time?
2. Eighteen workers are doing a job. Each worker is on duty once every 18 days. If Ali was
first on duty on Sunday, which day of the week will he be on duty for the thirty-sixth time?
3. A boy feeds his pigeons once every eight hours. He first fed the pigeons at nine oclock in
the morning. At what time will he feed his pigeons for the fiftieth time?
4. If January 1, 1994 was a Friday, which day of the week was January 1, 2000?
Answers
1. Sunday 2. Sunday 3. at 5 oclock 4. Friday
Modular Arithmetic
293
Objectives
A. BASIC CONCEPT
1. Binary Operations
Definition
binary operation
A binary operation is an operation which takes two elements of a set and maps them to only
one element of the set.
For example, multiplication and addition are binary operations on the set of integers, since
when we multiply two integers, we find only one integer as the product. So multiplication
maps two integers to only one integer.
We show regular multiplication with the product symbol: x or . Some other very common
operation symbols are +, and . If we define a new binary operation, we need to use a new
operation symbol. Some examples of symbols we could use are , , , , , , etc.
For example, let us define a binary operation on the set of natural numbers as
x y = x + y + 3. We can read this as x delta y is equal to x plus y plus 3.
Now let us calculate 4 5 and 10 2:
4 5 = 4 + 5 + 3 = 12 and 10 2 = 10 + 2 + 3 = 15.
EXAMPLE
18
y = 2x + 3y 4.
Solution
b. 5
a. 2
y = 2x + 3y 4
c. 1
a. 2
1 = (2 2) + (3 1) 4 = 3. So 2
b. 5
6 = (2 5) + (3 6) 4 = 10 + 18 4 = 24. So 5
d. 9
1 = 3.
6 = 24.
c. 1 3 = (2 (1)) + (3 3) 4 = 2 + 6 4 = 8 + 6 = 2. So 1 3 = 2.
d. 9
294
4 = (2 9) + (3 4) 4 = 18 + 12 4 = 26. So 9
4 = 26.
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
19
Solution
b. 5 0
a. x y 2x + 4y (mod 6)
b. 5 0 (2 5 + 4 0) (mod 6)
2 4 (2 2 + 4 4) (mod 6)
5 0 10 4 (mod 6)
2 4 4 + 16 20 2 (mod 6)
0 1 = (0 + 1) (mod 5) = 1 (mod 5)
2 3 = (2 + 3) (mod 5) = 0 (mod 5)
3 4 = (3 + 4) (mod 5) = 2 (mod 5)
EXAMPLE
20
Solution
1 2 2 1 2 (mod 6) 4 (mod 6)
3 4 2 3 4 = 24 0 (mod 6)
0 5 2 0 5 (mod 6) 0 (mod 6)
.
.
.
.
.
.
If we continue the calculations we can construct the
table for the operation (shown opposite).
Modular Arithmetic
295
EXAMPLE
21
a
b
a. a c = a
b. d e
c. b a
b. d e = c
c. b a = e
Check Yourself 8
1. An operation is defined on N such that for
a, b N, a b = 3a + b 1. Find each result.
a. 0 2
b. 7 7
c. 15 20
d. 1 100
b. 3 2
c. 6 7
d. 0 1
b. A M
c. E A
d. K M
Answers
1. a. 1 b. 27 c. 64 d. 102 2. a. 3 b. 4 c. 1 d. 7
4. a. A b. M c. E d. E 5. 343
296
3.
0
1
2
3
4
5
0
0
2
4
0
2
4
1
5
1
3
5
1
3
2
4
0
2
4
0
2
3
3
5
1
3
5
1
4
2
4
0
2
4
0
5
1
3
5
1
3
5
Algebra 9
Property
22
Solution
We can see that all the entries in the table are elements of A. So x y A for all x, y A
and therefore A is closed under .
commutative property
Property
23
Solution
EXAMPLE
24
Solution
Modular Arithmetic
b
297
associative property
Property
25
Solution
x (y z) = x (y + z + 1)
= x + (y + z + 1) + 1
= x + y + z + 2 and
(x y) z = (x + y + 1) z
= (x + y + 1) + z + 1
=x+y+z+2
So x (y z) = (x y) z, and therefore is associative in Z.
identity element
Property
26
Solution
For all a, b R the operation is defined as a b = a + b 2ab. Find the identity element for
in R.
Let e be the identity element for .
a e = a + e 2ae = a
If there is an identity
element in a set then
the element is unique.
An operation does not
always have an identity
element.
e(1 2a) = 0
e=0
Check: 0 a = 0 + a 2 0 a = a. So zero is the identity element.
inverse element
Property
27
Solution
298
Algebra 9
If x y = y x = y
then y is called the
null element for D.
If there is a null
element it is unique.
EXAMPLE
28
5x=e5+x25x2=1
9x = 2
2
x .
9
So the inverse of 5 is
2
for in R.
9
b. Is A closed under ?
c. Is commutative?
f. Find (a b) d.
a. Yes, it is a binary operation since maps every possible pair of elements in A to another
element of A.
b. All the numbers in the table are elements of A, so for all x, y A, x y A and therefore
A is closed under .
c. The table is symmetric with respect to the main diagonal. This means that the equation
x y = x y is true for all x and y in A. So is commutative.
main column
main row
main diagonal
d. The entries in the row and column for the element a in the table are the same as the
entries in the main row and the main column. Therefore the operation with a does not
change the original element. So a is the identity element in A for .
e. d is the inverse of c since c d = a (and a is the identity element).
b is the inverse of e since e b = a.
f. (a b) d = 2 d = e
g. (b c1) (a e1) = (b d) (a b)
= e b = a.
Modular Arithmetic
299
EXAMPLE
29
Solution
2 + 21 + 3 = 3
21 = 8
EXAMPLE
30
Solution
a1=a+1
a (a 1 ) = a (a + 1)
a (a + 1) = aa+1 = 81
aa+1 = 34
a= 3
Check Yourself 9
1. The operation is defined on the set A = {0, 1, 2, 3, 4} as shown in the table.
a. Is the set A closed under ?
e. Find x if (3 x) 4 = 0.
Answers
1. a. Yes b. Yes c. 2 d. 2 and 0 e. 2 f. 2 2. 13 3. 4 4. there is no identity element 5. 2
300
Algebra 9
EXERCISES
4 .1
5. Solve the equations.
b. 33 x (mod 12)
a. x 1 3 (mod 4) b. 5 x 2 (mod 6)
c. 45 x (mod 6)
d. 27 x (mod 5)
e. 125 x (mod 7)
f. 39 x (mod 8)
e. 2x 4 (mod 6)
g. 1278 x (mod 4)
h. 336 x (mod 9)
g. 3x 2 1 (mod 4) h. 3x 4 1 (mod 5)
f. 5x 3 (mod 4)
i. 2x 4 3 (mod 5) j. x
1 4 (mod 7)
k. x2 1 (mod 8)
l. x2
3 0 (mod 6)
a. 511 x (mod 6)
b. 8888 x (mod 9)
d. 13 + 15 + 18 + 9 x (mod 7)
c. 15143 x (mod 9)
e. 333 x (mod 9)
f. 3300 x (mod 5)
b. 42 + n 3 (mod 7)
c. n + 12 + 13 5 (mod 12)
d. 6 + 9 + n 7 (mod 9)
a. (7 8) = x (mod 6)
b. (9 13) x (mod 7)
c. 8 9 10 x (mod 11)
d. (4 + 3) 5 x (mod 4)
e. 4 5 + 3 5 x (mod 4)
f. (33 + 22) 43 x (mod 5)
Modular Arithmetic
Find 9 1.
1001 times
16. Ali is ill. His doctor has given him twelve pills,
and Ali must take one pill every five hours. If Ali
takes his first pill at 5 p.m., at what time will he
take his last pill?
as shown in the
table.
c. Find x if [(2 x) 4] 1 = 3.
d. Find 2 (3 1)1.
Algebra 9
4A
6. x is a two-digit integer. What is the greatest
B) 2
C) 3
D) 4
B) 4:00
B) 44
C) 88
D) 96
C) 5:00
D) 6:00
B) Friday
C) Tuesday
D) Wednesday
A) 3
B) 5
C) 2
D) 8
B) 4
C) 6
D) 7
B) 2
C) 3
D) 0
B) 2
C) 3
A) Friday
B) Saturday
C) Sunday
D) Tuesday
A) 144
B) 121
C) 81
D) 64
303
B) {1, 3}
C) {1, 4}
D) {1, 3, 4}
x y = xy yx and x y = 2xy.
Find 3 (2 1).
A) 13
Find (b d) (a c).
A) a
B) b
C) c
B) 15
C) 16
D) 17
B) 2
C) 3
D) 4
D) d
B) 7
C) 6
D) 3
Find a if a 1 = 2 3.
A) 4
B) 5
C) 6
D) 7
A = {M, A, T, H, S} A
as shown in the
table.
What is (2 3) 4?
A) 36
304
B) 48
C) 56
D) 125
A) M
B) A
C) T
D) H
Algebra 9
Definition
An experiment is an activity or a process which has observable results. For example, rolling a
die is an experiment.
The possible results of an experiment are called outcomes. The outcomes of rolling a die once are
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
The set of all possible outcomes of an experiment is called the sample space for the experiment.
The sample space for rolling a die once is {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}.
An event is a subset of (or a part of) a sample space. For example, the event of an odd number
being rolled on a die is {1, 3, 5}.
If the sample space of an experiment with n outcomes is S = {e1, e2, e3, e4, , en} then the
events {e1}, {e2}, {e3}, , {en} which consist of exactly one outcome are called simple events.
EXAMPLE
Solution
EXAMPLE
Solution
EXAMPLE
Solution
306
The sample space is {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, TTH, TTT}.
The sample space for an experiment is {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9}. Write the event that the result
is a prime number.
The event is {2, 3, 5, 7}.
Algebra 9
Definition
The union of two events A and B is the set of all outcomes which are in A and/or B. It is
denoted by A B.
The intersection of two events A and B is the set of all outcomes in both A and B. It is
denoted by A B.
The complement of an event A is the set of all outcomes in the sample space that are not in
the event A. It is denoted by A (or AC ).
A
Solution
S
AB
(union of A and B)
EXAMPLE
AB
(intersection of A and B)
A
(complement of A)
Consider the events A = {1, 2, 3, 4} and B = {4, 5, 6} in the experiment of rolling a die.
Write the events A B, A B and A.
The sample space for this experiment is {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Therefore,
A B = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6} (the set of all outcomes in events A and/or B);
A B = {4} (the set of all common outcomes in A and B);
A = {5, 6} (the set of all outcomes in the sample space that are not in event A).
Definition
S
A and B are mutually exclusive events.
Probablty
307
Definition
Let E be an event in a sample space S in which all the outcomes are equally likely to occur.
n( E)
, where n(E) is the number of outcomes in
n(S)
event E and n(S) is the number of outcomes in the sample space S.
EXAMPLE
Solution
EXAMPLE
Solution
EXAMPLE
Solution
n( E) 3 1
= = .
n(S) 6 2
308
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
Solution
The integers 1 through 15 are written on separate cards. You are asked to pick a card at
random. What is the probability that you pick a prime number?
There are fifteen numbers in the sample space. The primes in the set are 2, 3, 5, 7, 11 and
6
2
.
13. So the desired probability is
15 5
Remark
Since the number of outcomes in an event is always less than or equal to the number of
n( E)
outcomes in the sample space,
is always less than or equal to 1.
n(S)
Also, the smallest possible number of outcomes in an event is zero. So the smallest possible
n( E)
0
probability ratio is
0.
n(S) n(S)
In conclusion, the probability of an event always lies between 0 and 1, i.e. 0 P(E) 1.
EXAMPLE
Solution
.
n(board) 81 9
As the probability of an event gets closer to 1, the event is more likely to occur. As it gets
closer to zero, the event is less likely to occur. In the previous example, the probability is close
1
to zero so the event is not very likely. However, note that
does not tell us anything about
9
what will actually happen as the child is throwing the darts. The child will not necessarily hit
the red circle once every nine darts. He might hit it three times with nine darts, or not at all.
But if the child played for a long time and we looked at the ratio of the red hits, to the other
1
hits we would find that it is close to .
9
Probablty
309
Definition
An event whose probability is 1 is called a certain event. An event whose probability is zero is
called an impossible event.
EXAMPLE
10
Solution
EXAMPLE
11
Solution
EXAMPLE
12
Solution
13 1
= .
52 4
The bulb only lights when all the switches are closed. So the desired probability is
310
1
.
8
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
13
Solution
In a game, a player bets on a number from 2 to 12 and rolls two dice. If the sum of the spots
on the dice is the number he guessed, he wins the game. Which number would you advise
the player to bet on? Why?
There is no difference between rolling a die twice and rolling two dice
together. Let us make a table of the possible outcomes of rolling the
dice:
Probability (%)
15
10
9 10 11 12
We can see that there are six ways of rolling 7 with two dice. This is the most frequent
outcome of the game, so the player should bet on 7. As there are 6 6 = 36 outcomes in the
6
1
sample space, the probability of rolling 7 is
= , which is the highest probability in the
36 6
game.
Check Yourself 1
1. A family with three children is selected from a population and the genders (male or
female) of the children are written in order, from oldest to youngest. If M represents a
male child and F represents a female child, write the sample space for this experiment.
2. A student rolls a die which has one white face, two red faces and three blue faces. What is
the probability that the top face is blue?
3. Two dice are rolled together. What is the probability of obtaining a sum less than 6?
4. A box contains 15 light bulbs, 4 of which are defective. A bulb is selected at random. What
is the probability that it is not defective?
5. Three dice are rolled together. What is the probability of rolling a sum of 15?
Answers
1. {MMM, MMF, MFM, FMM, MFF, FMF, FFM, FFF} 2.
Probablty
1
2
3. 5
18
4.
11
15
5.
5
108
311
EXERCISES
5 .1
10.
1
2
3
Objectives
A. BASIC CONCEPTS
1. What is Statistics?
Statistics is the science of collecting, organizing, summarizing and analyzing data, and drawing
conclusions
from
this
data.
In
every
field,
from
the
humanities to the physical sciences, research information and the ways in which it is collected and measured can be inaccurate. Statistics is the
discipline that evaluates the reliability of numerical information, called data.
We use statistics to describe what is happening, and to make projections
concerning what will happen in the future. Statistics show the results of our
experience.
Many different people such as economists, engineers, geographers, biologists, physicists, meteorologists and managers use statistics in their work.
Definition
Statistics
Statistics is a branch of mathematics which deals with the collection, analysis, interpretation,
and representation of masses of numerical data.
The word statistics comes from the Latin word statisticus, meaning of the state.
The steps of statistical analysis involve collecting information, evaluating it, and drawing conclusions.
For example, the information might be about:
what teenagers prefer to eat for breakfast;
the population of a city over a certain period;
the quality of drinking water in different countries of the world;
the number of items produced in a factory.
Statistics
313
2. Collecting Data
We can collect data in many different ways.
a. Questionnaires
A questionnaire is a list of questions about a given topic. It is usually printed on a piece of
paper so that the answers can be recorded.
For example, suppose you want to find out about the television viewing habits of teachers. You
could prepare a list of questions such as:
Do you watch television every day?
Do you watch television: in the morning?
in the evening?
What is your favourite television program?
etc.
Some questions will have a yes or no answer. Other questions might ask a person to choose
an answer from a list, or to give a free answer.
When you are writing a questionnaire, keep the following points in mind:
1. A questionnaire should not be too long.
2. It should contain all the questions needed to cover the subject you are studying.
3. The questions should be easy to understand.
4. Most questions should only require a Yes/No answer, a tick in a box or a circle round a
choice.
In the example of a study about teachers television viewing habits, we only need to ask the
questions to teachers. Teachers form the population for our study. A more precise population
could be all the teachers in your country, or all the teachers in your school.
population
sample
A sample is a subset of a
population.
314
b. Sampling
A sample is a group of subjects selected from a population. Suppose the population for our
study about television is all the teachers in a particular city. Obviously it will be very difficult
to interview every teacher in the city individually. Instead we could choose a smaller group of
teachers to interview, for example,
Algebra 9
five teachers from each school. These teachers will be the sample for our study. We could say
that the habits of the teachers in this sample are probably the same as the habits of all the
teachers in the city.
The process of choosing a sample from a population is called sampling.
The process of choosing a sample from a population is called sampling.
When we sample a population, we need to make sure that the sample is an accurate one. For
example, if we are choosing five teachers from each school to represent all the teachers in a
city, we will need to make sure that the sample includes teachers of different ages in different
parts of the city. When we have chosen an accurate sample for our study, we can collect the
data we need and apply statistical methods to make statements about the whole population.
c. Surveys
One of the most common method of collecting data is the use of surveys. Surveys can be carried out using a variety of methods. Three of the most common methods are the telephone
survey, the mailed questionnaire, and the personal interview.
3. Summarizing Data
In order to describe a situation, draw conclusions, or make predictions about events, a
researcher must organize the data in a meaningful way. One
convenient way of organizing the data is by using a frequency distribution table.
a sample. It is denoted
A frequency distribution table consists of two rows or columns. One row or column shows the
data values (x) and the other shows the frequency of each value (f). The frequency of a value
is the number of times it occurs in the data set.
by n.
For example, imagine that 25 students took a math test and received the
10
10
Statistics
following marks.
frequency dis-
mark
(x)
10
frequency
(f)
315
We can see from the table that the frequency of 7 is 3 and the frequency of 8 is 5.
The sum of the frequencies is equal to the total number of marks (25).
The number of students took test is called the sample size (n). In this example the sample
size is 25.
The sum of the frequencies and the sample size are the same.
EXAMPLE
14
Twenty-five students were given a blood test to determine their blood type. The data set was
as follows:
A
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
Construct a frequency
each blood type.
Solution
class
frequency
percent
16 %
28 %
We can use the following formula to find the percentage of values in each class:
f
% = 100% where
n
36 %
AB
20 %
Total 25
Total 100
316
present it in a
Graphs are an easy way of displaying data. There are three kinds of graph:
bar graph, and a circle graph (also called a pie chart).
a line graph, a
Algebra 9
1. Bar Grap
The most common type of graph is the bar graph (also called a histogram). A bar graph uses
rectangular bars to represent data. The length of each bar in the graph shows the frequency
or size of a cooresponding data value.
EXAMPLE
15
Solution
The following table shows the marks that a student received at the
end of the year in different school subjects. Draw a vertical bar
graph for the data in table.
We begin by drawing a vertical scale to show the marks and a horizontal scale to show the subjects.
Subject
Mark
Maths
Physics
Chemistry
Biology
Computer
10
History
Music
Music
History
Computer
Biology
Chemistry
Physics
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Mathematics
Marks
Then we can draw bars to show the marks for each subject.
Lessons
2. Line Graph
We can make a line graph (also called a broken-line graph) by drawing line segments to join
the tops of the bars in a bar graph.
For example, look at the line graph of the data from Example 5.2.
Statistics
317
Music
History
Computer
Biology
Chemistry
Physics
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Mathematics
Music
History
Marks
Lessons
Computer
Biology
Chemistry
Physics
Mathematics
Marks
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Lessons
To draw the line graph, we mark the middle point of the top of each bar and join up the points
with straight lines.
EXAMPLE
16
Solution
318
First we need to choose the axes. Let us put the years along the horizontal axis and the production along the vertical axis of the graph.
It will be difficult to show large numbers such as 133 006 on the
vertical axis. Instead, we can choose a different unit for the vertical
axis, for example: one unit on the axis means 10 000 cars. We write
this information when we label the axis.
Car Production
Year
Production
1992
110 659
1993
133 006
1994
99 326
1995
74 862
1996
65 007
1997
91 326
1998
88 506
1999
125 026
2000
140 159
Algebra 9
1999
2000
2000
1998
1998
1999
1997
1997
1996
1995
1994
1993
0
1992
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
1996
1995
1994
1993
0
1992
Year
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
Year
6%
6.4%
5.3%
5.2%
5
4
6%
Australia
7%
Norway
3.4%
2
1
Germany
0
Canada
United
Kingdom
USA
17
Turkey
EXAMPLE
Statistics
319
Solution
c. 7 3.4 = 3.6%
d. Norway and Australia spent the same percentage: both countries gave 6% of their GDP.
Check Yourself 1
1. The bar graph below compares different causes of death in the United States for the year
1999. Look at the graph and answer the questions.
Comparative causes of annual deaths in the United States (1999)*
320
Algebra 9
f
360
n
where f is the frequency of the result and n is the total number of results in the sample.
Activity
Time
(Percent)
For example, a student calculated the number of hours she spent doing
different activities during a period of 24 hours. The results are shown in the table opposite.
School hours
7 hours (30%)
Resting
1 hours (4%)
Playing
computer games
2 hours (8%)
Studying
3 hours (12%)
Resting
Watching TV
2 hours (8%)
Sleeping
7 hours (30%)
Other
2 hours (8%)
There are 24 hours in day, so we will divide the circle into 24 (n = 24). The central angle
for each sector is:
School hours
Studying
7
360 =105
24
1
360 =15
24
2
360 = 30
24
3
360 = 45 .
24
Watching TV
Sleeping
Other
2
360 = 30
24
7
360 =105
24
2
360 = 30
24
Now we can use a protractor to graph each section and write its name and corresponding percentage.
Other: 2 hours (8%)
School hours: 7 hours (30%)
Statistics
321
EXAMPLE
18
The table shows the estimated population of different countries in the world in 2003.
a. Find the percentage of the world population for each country.
b. Make a circle graph to
Solution
b. Each sector of the circle graph will show the population of a country. We can use the formula
f
360
n
to find the central angle of each sector, where f is the countrys population and n is the
total world population: 6301 million. For example, the central angle for China will be
1304
360 74.5 .
6301
Population
Population
Percent
Central angle
(est.)(millions)
China
1304
20.7 %
74.5
China
1304
India
1065
16.9 %
60.8
India
1065
U.S.A
294
4.7 %
16.8
USA
294
Indonesia
220
3.5 %
12.6
Indonesia
220
Brasil
178
Brasil
178
2.8 %
10.2
Other
3240
51.4 %
185.1
Country
Other
Country
2003
3240
Estimated world
population in 2003 (Millions)
Brasil
Indonesia
U.S.A.
India
Other
China
322
Algebra 9
Check Yourself 2
1. Fifteen people applied for a job. Their ages were as follows:
35
27
19
18
16
42
19
22
56
25
30
36
50
21
18
the daily high temperatures (in degrees celsius) for the month
31
31
30
30
29
32
30
31
29
30
30
29
32
27
32
177
171
142
160
5. The bar graph below shows the vegetable production (measured in thousands of tons) in
Turkey between 1998 and 2003.
Statistics
2003
2002
2001
2000
24 500
24 000
23 500
23 000
22 500
22 000
21 500
21 000
20 500
20 000
19 500
1998
1000 tons
year
323
Number
367
Cooking
268
Children
98
Naked flames
120
Cigarette
188
Arson
210
Unknown
189
Statistics
The mean of a set of data is the arithmetic average of the set of data.
In other words, the mean of a set of data is the sum of all the values, divided by the number
of values in the set.
For example, consider the set of data 13, 15, 19, 23, 16, 14, 21, 17, 12, 10. There are ten values. To find the mean, we add all the values and divide by the number of values.
m ean =
13+15+19+23+16+14+21+17+12+10 160
=
=16.
10
10
324
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
19
Solution
EXAMPLE
20
Solution
a. mean =
7+2+4+6+3+5+7+4+3+5+9 55
= =5
11
11
b. mean =
52+63+72+59+61+40+45+49+67
= 56.444...
9
The arithmetic mean of two numbers a and b is 22, and a is four more than b times three.
Find a.
Statistics
When we arrange the values in a set of data in either ascending or descending order, the middle value is called the median.
To find the median of a set of data, follow the steps:
1. Arrange the values in numerical order (from the smallest to largest).
2. If there is an odd number of values, the median is the middle value.
3. If there is an even number of values, the median is the mean of the two middle values.
The median divides a set into two parts, with half of the numbers below the median and other
half above it.
Statistics
325
EXAMPLE
21
Solution
15+17
=16.
2
3. Mode
The third important measure of central tendency is the mode.
Definition
Statistics
The mode of a set of data values is the value in the set that appears most
frequently.
To find the mode, you can order the values and count each one. The most
frequently occurring value is the mode.
EXAMPLE
22
Solution
63 , 63 , 63 , 64,
65 , 65 , 65 , 67, 67
Algebra 9
EXAMPLE
23
In a fast-food restaurant the following orders are taken. Find the mode of the given data.
pizza, chips, pizza, hot dog, sandwich, pizza, chips, sandwich, hot dog, pizza, hot dog, pizza.
Solution
pizza, pizza, pizza, pizza, pizza, chips, chips, hot dog, hot dog, hot dog,
5 times
sandwich, sandwich.
2 times
3 times
2 times
The mode is pizza. It appears five times.
4. Range
Definition
Statistics
The difference between the largest and the smallest value in a set of data is called the range
of the data set.
EXAMPLE
24
Solution
To find the range we subtract the smallest value from the largest value in the set of data. The
largest value is 16 and the smallest value is 1.
So 16 1 = 15, and the range is 15.
Statistics
327
Check Yourself 3
1. Find the mean, median, mode and range for each set of data.
a. 4, 9, 6, 3, 7, 5, 6, 8
b. 22, 23, 45, 64, 45, 32, 52, 23, 54
c. 75, 77, 61, 68, 68, 74, 74, 70, 70, 69, 68
d. 256, 285, 245, 256, 227, 263, 256, 285, 256
3. The data below show the number of visitors to a restaurant on each day of a month. Find
the mean, median, mode, and range of this data.
328
19,
20,
23,
25,
27,
30
21,
33,
46,
49,
52,
33
45,
43,
40,
52,
63,
35
31,
45,
22,
44,
56,
61
22,
23,
27,
33,
35,
37
Algebra 9
4
5 .2
Entertainment
13%
100 000
Clothing
10%
Books
15%
Other
5%
Basketball
Volleyball
Swiming
12
Wrestling
Karate
Judo
gas
60%
insurance
20%
Horse Mackerel
295
Scad
16
Gray mullet
12
Blue fish
11
Pilchard
11
Whiting
12
Hake
Other
32
Modular Arithmetic
2003
200 000
2002
300 000
27%
Rent
2001
2000
Expenses
Food
Sport
Football
1999
EXERCISES
329
4A
5
6.
D) 18
B) 9
C) 12
winter
B) 16
autumn
A) 15
3000
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
summer
spring
D) 13
A) 7000 kg
B) 6500 kg
C) 6000 kg
D) 5500 kg
B) 15
C) 16
D) 17
7.
wheat (tons)
35
30
A) 0
B) 1
C) 2
D) 3
25
20
15
10
2003
2002
2001
2000
5
year
A) 180
A) 25%
330
B) 160
C) 108
D) 90
B) 50%
C) 75%
D) 100%
Algebra 9
11.
sleeping
35%
temperature (C)
30
25
studying
15%
school
30%
other
15%
20
15
10
eating
5%
5
0
Mon.
A) 8 hours
B) 7.2 hours
C) 3.6 hours
D) 9 hours
days
B) 19
C) 20
D) 24
B) $3
books
20%
food
30%
entertainment
20%
other
5%
C) $4
transportation
25%
D) $5
B) 12
C) 13
D) 14
B) 36
C) 64
D) 82
B) 120
C) 80
D) 60
331